blob: bf1e4cb730c45b579d604f0abf43163a7c8c6fcd [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauca3551f2019-06-11 19:28:00 +02007 2019/06/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200480A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
481which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
482
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200483
4842.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200485----------------
486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100487Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100488values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
489otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
490numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
491for every keyword. Supported units are :
492
493 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
494 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
495 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
496 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
497 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
498 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
499
500
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005012.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200502-------------
503
504 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
505 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
506 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
507 global
508 daemon
509 maxconn 256
510
511 defaults
512 mode http
513 timeout connect 5000ms
514 timeout client 50000ms
515 timeout server 50000ms
516
517 frontend http-in
518 bind *:80
519 default_backend servers
520
521 backend servers
522 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
523
524
525 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
526 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
527 global
528 daemon
529 maxconn 256
530
531 defaults
532 mode http
533 timeout connect 5000ms
534 timeout client 50000ms
535 timeout server 50000ms
536
537 listen http-in
538 bind *:80
539 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
540
541
542Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
543
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100544 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200545
546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005473. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548--------------------
549
550Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
551are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
552of them have command-line equivalents.
553
554The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
555
556 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200557 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200559 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200560 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200562 - description
563 - deviceatlas-json-file
564 - deviceatlas-log-level
565 - deviceatlas-separator
566 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900567 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200568 - gid
569 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100570 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200572 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100573 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200574 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200575 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200577 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200579 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100580 - presetenv
581 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - uid
583 - ulimit-n
584 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200585 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100586 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200587 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-bind-options
591 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200592 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200593 - ssl-default-server-options
594 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100595 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100596 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100597 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100598 - 51degrees-data-file
599 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200600 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200601 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200602 - wurfl-data-file
603 - wurfl-information-list
604 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200605 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100606
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200608 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200610 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100611 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100612 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100613 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200614 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200615 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200616 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200617 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618 - noepoll
619 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000620 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200621 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100622 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300623 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000624 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100625 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200626 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200627 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200628 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000629 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000630 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200631 - tune.buffers.limit
632 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200633 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200634 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100635 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200636 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200637 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200638 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100639 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200640 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200641 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100642 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100644 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100645 - tune.lua.session-timeout
646 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200647 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100648 - tune.maxaccept
649 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200650 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200651 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200652 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100653 - tune.rcvbuf.client
654 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100655 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200656 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100657 - tune.sndbuf.client
658 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100659 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200661 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100662 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200663 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200664 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100665 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100667 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200668 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
669 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
670 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100671 - tune.zlib.memlevel
672 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674 * Debugging
675 - debug
676 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200677
678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006793.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680------------------------------------
681
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200682ca-base <dir>
683 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200684 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
685 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200686
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200687chroot <jail dir>
688 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
689 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
690 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
691 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
692 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100693 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100694
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100695cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
696 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
697 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
698 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
699 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
700 set. These sets have the format
701
702 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
703
704 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100705 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100706 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
707 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100708 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
709 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100711 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100713 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100714 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
715 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
716 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
717 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100718
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100719 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
720 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
721 on the machine's word size.
722
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100723 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100724 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
725 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
726 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
727 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
728 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
729 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100730
731 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
733
734 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
735 # first 4 CPUs
736
737 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
738 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
739 # word size.
740
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100743 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
744 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
745 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
746
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
748 # and so on.
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
750 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
751 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
752
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100753 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100754 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
755 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
756 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
757
758 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
759 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
760 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
761
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100762 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
763 # and a thread range.
764 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
765 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
766 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
767
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200768crt-base <dir>
769 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
770 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
771 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
772
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773daemon
774 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
775 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100776 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
777 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200778
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200779deviceatlas-json-file <path>
780 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100781 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200782
783deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100784 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200785 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
786
787deviceatlas-separator <char>
788 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
789 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
790
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100791deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200792 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
793 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
794 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100795
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900796external-check
797 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
798 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
799 See "option external-check".
800
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200801gid <number>
802 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
803 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
804 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100805 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
806 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100808
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100809hard-stop-after <time>
810 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
811
812 Arguments :
813 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
814 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
815 SIGUSR1 signal.
816
817 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
818 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
819 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
820
821 Example:
822 global
823 hard-stop-after 30s
824
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200825group <group name>
826 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
827 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100828
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200829log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
830 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100831 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100832 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100833 configured with "log global".
834
835 <address> can be one of:
836
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100837 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100838 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
839 port).
840
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100841 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
842 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
843 port).
844
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100845 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
847 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100848 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100849
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100850 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
851 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
852 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
853 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
854 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
855 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
856 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
857 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
858 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
859 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
860 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
861 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
862 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
863 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100864 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
865 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100866
867 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
868 "fd@2", see above.
869
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200870 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
871 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100872
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200873 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
874 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
875 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
876 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
877 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
878 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
879 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
880 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
881 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
882 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100883 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
884 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200885
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200886 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
887 one of the following :
888
889 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
891
892 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
893 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
894
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100895 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
896 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
897 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
898 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
899 logger consumes.
900
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100901 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
902 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
903 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
904 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
905
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200906 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
907 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
908 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
909 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
910 set with <sample_size> parameter.
911
912 <sample_size>
913 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
914 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
915 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
916 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
917 (see also <ranges> parameter).
918
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100919 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200920
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100921 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
922 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
923 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
924
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100925 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
926 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
927 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
928 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200929
930 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200931 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
932 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
933 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
934 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
935 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
936 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200937
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200938 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200939
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100940log-send-hostname [<string>]
941 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
942 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
943 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
944 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
945 the logs.
946
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000947log-tag <string>
948 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
949 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
950 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100951 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000952
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100953lua-load <file>
954 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
955 used multiple times.
956
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100957master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200958 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
959 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
960 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100961 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200962 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
963 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100964 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
965 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
966 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
967 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
968 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200969
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100970 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200971
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200972mworker-max-reloads <number>
973 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
974 survive to a reload. If the worker did not left after a reload, once its
975 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
976 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
977 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
978
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200979nbproc <number>
980 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
981 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
982 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100983 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
984 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100985 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
986 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200988nbthread <number>
989 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100990 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
991 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
992 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
993 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
994 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100995 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
996 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
997 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
998 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
999 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1000 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1001 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001002
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001004 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1006 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1007
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001008presetenv <name> <value>
1009 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1010 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1011 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1012 and "unsetenv".
1013
1014resetenv [<name> ...]
1015 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1016 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1017 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1018 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1019 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1020 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1021 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1022 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1023
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001024stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001025 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1026 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1027 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1028 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1029 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1030 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001031 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001032 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1033 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1034 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1035 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001036
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001037server-state-base <directory>
1038 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001039 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1040 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001041
1042server-state-file <file>
1043 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1044 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1045 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1046 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1047 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1048 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1049 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1050 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001051 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1052 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001053
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001054setenv <name> <value>
1055 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1056 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1057 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1058 and "unsetenv".
1059
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001060set-dumpable
1061 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1062 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1063 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1064 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1065 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1066 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1067 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1068 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1069 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1070 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1071 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1072 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1073 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1074 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1075 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1076 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1077 expected when dying.
1078
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001079ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1080 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1081 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001082 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001083 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001084 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1085 information and recommendations see e.g.
1086 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1087 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1088 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1089 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001090
1091ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1093 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1094 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1095 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1096 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001097 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1098 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1099 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001100 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001101
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001102ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1104 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1105 keyword to see available options.
1106
1107 Example:
1108 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001109 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001110
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001111ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1112 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1113 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001114 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001115 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001116 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1117 information and recommendations see e.g.
1118 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1119 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1120 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1121 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1122 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001123
1124ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1126 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1127 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1128 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1129 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001130 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1131 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1132 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1133 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001134
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001135ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1136 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1137 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1138 keyword to see available options.
1139
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001140ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1142 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1143 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001144 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001145 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001146 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1147 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1148 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1149 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001150 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1151 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1152 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1153
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001154ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1155 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1156 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1157 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1158
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001159stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1160 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1161 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1162 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001163 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001164 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001165
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001166 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1167 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1168 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001169
1170stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1171 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1172 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001173 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001174
1175stats maxconn <connections>
1176 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1177 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1178
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001179uid <number>
1180 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1181 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1182 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1183 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1184
1185ulimit-n <number>
1186 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1187 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1188 option.
1189
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001190unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1191 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1192
1193 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1194 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1195 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1196 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1197 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1198 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1199 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1200 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1201 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1202 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1203
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001204unsetenv [<name> ...]
1205 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1206 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1207 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1208 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1209 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1210 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1211 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1212
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001213user <user name>
1214 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1215 See also "uid" and "group".
1216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001217node <name>
1218 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1219
1220 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1221 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1222 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1223 traffic.
1224
1225description <text>
1226 Add a text that describes the instance.
1227
1228 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1229 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1230 "<" and ">" characters.
1231
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100123251degrees-data-file <file path>
1233 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001234 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001235
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001236 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001237 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1238
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000123951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001240 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1241 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1242 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1243
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001244 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001245 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1246
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200124751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001248 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1249 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1250
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001251 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1252 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1253
125451degrees-cache-size <number>
1255 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1256 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1257 By default, this cache is disabled.
1258
1259 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001260 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1261
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001262wurfl-data-file <file path>
1263 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1264 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1265
1266 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1267 with USE_WURFL=1.
1268
1269wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1270 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1271 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1272 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1273
1274 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1275
1276 Valid WURFL properties are:
1277 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1278
1279 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1280 device.
1281
1282 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1283 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1284
1285 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1286 particular web request.
1287
1288 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1289 used Libwurfl API version.
1290
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001291 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1292 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1293
1294 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1295 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1296
1297 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1298
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001299 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1300 with USE_WURFL=1.
1301
1302wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1303 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1304 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1305
1306 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1307 with USE_WURFL=1.
1308
1309wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1310 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1311 thus before the chroot.
1312
1313 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1314 with USE_WURFL=1.
1315
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001316wurfl-cache-size <size>
1317 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1318 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001319 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001320 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001321
1322 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1323 with USE_WURFL=1.
1324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013253.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001326-----------------------
1327
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001328busy-polling
1329 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1330 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1331 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1332 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1333 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1334 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1335 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1336 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1337 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1338 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1339 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1340 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1341 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1342 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1343 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1344 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1345 "poll" pollers.
1346
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001347max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1348 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1349 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1350 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1351 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1352 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1353 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1354 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1355 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1356
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001357maxconn <number>
1358 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1359 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1360 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001361 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1362 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1363 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1364 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001365 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1366 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1367 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1368 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1369 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1370 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001371
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001372maxconnrate <number>
1373 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1374 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1375 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1376 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1377 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1378 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1379 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1380 fairness.
1381
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001382maxcomprate <number>
1383 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001384 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001385 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1386 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1387 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001388 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001389 default value.
1390
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001391maxcompcpuusage <number>
1392 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1393 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1394 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1395 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1396 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1397 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1398 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1399 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1400
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001401maxpipes <number>
1402 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1403 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1404 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1405 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1406 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1407 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1408
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001409maxsessrate <number>
1410 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1411 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1412 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1413 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1414 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1415 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1416 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1417 fairness.
1418
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001419maxsslconn <number>
1420 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1421 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1422 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1423 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1424 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1425 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1426 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001427 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1428 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1429 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1430 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1431 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1432 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1433 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001434
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001435maxsslrate <number>
1436 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1437 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1438 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1439 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1440 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1441 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1442 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1443 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1444 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1445 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1446
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001447maxzlibmem <number>
1448 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1449 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1450 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001451 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1452 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1453 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001455noepoll
1456 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1457 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001458 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001459
1460nokqueue
1461 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1462 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1463 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1464
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001465noevports
1466 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1467 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1468 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1469 also "nopoll".
1470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001471nopoll
1472 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1473 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001474 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001475 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1476 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001477
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001478nosplice
1479 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001480 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001481 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001482 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001483 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1484 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1485 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1486 "option splice-response".
1487
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001488nogetaddrinfo
1489 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1490 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1491
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001492noreuseport
1493 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1494 command line argument "-dR".
1495
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001496profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1497 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1498 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1499 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1500 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
1501 reutnrs below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
1502 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1503 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1504 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1505 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1506
1507 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1508 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1509 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1510 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1511 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001512 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1513 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1514 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1515 CLI.
1516
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001517spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001518 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1519 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1520 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1521 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1522 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1523 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001524
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001526 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001527 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001528 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1529 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1530 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1531 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1532 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001533 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1534 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001535 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1536 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1537 openssl configuration file uses:
1538 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1539
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001540ssl-mode-async
1541 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001542 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001543 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1544 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1545 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1546 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1547 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001548
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001549tune.buffers.limit <number>
1550 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1551 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1552 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1553 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1554 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001555 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001556 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1557 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1558 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1559 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1560 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1561 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1562 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1563 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1564 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1565
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001566tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1567 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1568 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1569 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1570 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1571
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001572tune.bufsize <number>
1573 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1574 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1575 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1576 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1577 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1578 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1579 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001580 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1581 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1582 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001583 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001584 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1585 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1586 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001587
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001588tune.chksize <number>
1589 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1590 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1591 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1592 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1593 checks whenever possible.
1594
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001595tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1596 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1597 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1598 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1599 this value. The default value is 1.
1600
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001601tune.fail-alloc
1602 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1603 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1604 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1605 gracefully.
1606
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001607tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1608 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1609 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1610 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1611 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1612 change it.
1613
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001614tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1615 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001616 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1617 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001618 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1619 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1620 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1621 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1622 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1623
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001624tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1625 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1626 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1627 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1628 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1629 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1630 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1631 recommended not to change this value.
1632
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001633tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1634 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1635 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1636 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1637 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1638 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1639 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1640 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1641
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001642tune.http.cookielen <number>
1643 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1644 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1645 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1646 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1647 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1648 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1649 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1650 to change this value.
1651
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001652tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001653 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1654 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001655 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001656 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001657 configuration directives too.
1658 The default value is 1024.
1659
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001660tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1661 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1662 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1663 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1664 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1665 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1666 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001667 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1668 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1669 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001670
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001671tune.idletimer <timeout>
1672 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1673 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1674 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1675 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1676 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1677 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001678 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001679 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1680 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1681
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001682tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1683 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1684 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1685 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1686 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1687 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1688 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1689 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1690 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1691 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1692
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001693tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1694 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001695 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001696 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1697 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001698 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001699 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1700 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1701
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001702tune.lua.maxmem
1703 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1704 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1705 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1706 memory.
1707
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001708tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1709 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001710 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1711 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001712 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001713
1714tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1715 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1716 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1717 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1718 check servers.
1719
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001720tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1721 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1722 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1723 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001724 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001725
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001726tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001727 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1728 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1729 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1730 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1731 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1732 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1733 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1734 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1735 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1736 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001737
1738tune.maxpollevents <number>
1739 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1740 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1741 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1742 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1743 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1744
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001745tune.maxrewrite <number>
1746 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1747 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1748 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1749 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1750 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1751 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1752 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1753 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1754 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1755 bufsize.
1756
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001757tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1758 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1759 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1760 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1761 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1762 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1763 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1764 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1765 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1766 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1767 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1768 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1769 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1770 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1771 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1772 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1773 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1774 setting this parameter to 0.
1775
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001776tune.pipesize <number>
1777 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1778 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1779 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1780 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1781 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1782 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1783
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001784tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1785 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1786 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1787 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1788 default is 20.
1789
1790tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1791 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1792 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1793 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1794 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1795 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1796 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
1797 much sense in the general case when targetting connection reuse).
1798
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001799tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1800tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1801 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1802 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1803 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1804 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001805 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001806 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1807 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1808
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001809tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001810 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001811 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1812 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1813 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1814 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1815
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001816tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1817 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1818 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1819 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1820
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001821tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1822tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1823 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1824 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1825 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1826 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001827 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001828 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1829 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1830 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1831 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1832 notifying haproxy again.
1833
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001834tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001835 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1836 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1837 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001838 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001839 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001840 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001841 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1842 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1843 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001844 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1845 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001846
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001847tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001848 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001849 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1850 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1851 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1852 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1853 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1854
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001855tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1856 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001857 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001858 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1859 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1860 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1861 being used for too long.
1862
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001863tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1864 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1865 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1866 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1867 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1868 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1869 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1870 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1871 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1872 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1873 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001874 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001875 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001876
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001877tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1878 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1879 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1880 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1881 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1882 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1883 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1884 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001885 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1886 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001887
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001888tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1889 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1890 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1891 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1892 1000 entries.
1893
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001894tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1895 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1896 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1897 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1898
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001899tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001900tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001901tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1902tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1903tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001904 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1905 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1906 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1907 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1908 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1909 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1910 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1911 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001912
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001913 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1914 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1915 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1916 all available space is consumed.
1917 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1918 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1919 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001920
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001921tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1922 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001923 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001924 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001925 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001926 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1927
1928tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1929 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1930 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001931 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1932 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019343.3. Debugging
1935--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001936
1937debug
1938 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1939 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1940 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1941 system startup.
1942
1943quiet
1944 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1945 line argument "-q".
1946
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019483.4. Userlists
1949--------------
1950It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1951http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1952it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1953
1954userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001955 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001956 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1957
1958group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001959 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001960 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1961 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1962
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001963user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1964 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001965 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1966 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001967 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1968 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1969 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1970 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001971
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001972 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1973 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1974 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1975 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1976 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1977 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1978 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1979 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1980 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001981
1982 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001983 userlist L1
1984 group G1 users tiger,scott
1985 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001986
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001987 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1988 user scott insecure-password elgato
1989 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001990
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001991 userlist L2
1992 group G1
1993 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001994
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001995 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1996 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1997 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001998
1999 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002000
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002001
20023.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002003----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002004It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2005several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2006instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2007values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2008automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2009In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2010using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2011tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2012reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2013Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2014that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2015each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002016
2017peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002018 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002019 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2020
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002021bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2022 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2023 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2024
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002025disabled
2026 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2027 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2028 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2029
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002030default-bind [param*]
2031 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2032
2033default-server [param*]
2034 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2035
2036 Arguments:
2037 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2038 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2039 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2040 details.
2041
2042
2043 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2044
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002045enable
2046 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2047
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002048peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002049 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2050 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2051 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2052 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2053 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2054 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2055
2056 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2057 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2058
2059 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2060 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2061 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2062 across all peers.
2063
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002064 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2065 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002066
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002067 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2068 "server" keyword explanation below).
2069
2070server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002071 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002072 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2073 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2074 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2075 of this "peers" section).
2076 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2077
2078
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002079 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002080 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002081 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002082 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2083 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2084 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002085
2086 backend mybackend
2087 mode tcp
2088 balance roundrobin
2089 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2090 stick on src
2091
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002092 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2093 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002094
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002095 Example:
2096 peers mypeers
2097 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2098 default-server ssl verify none
2099 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2100 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002101
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002102
2103table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2104 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2105
2106 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2107 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
2108 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an aditionnal
2109 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2110 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2111 "stick-table" keyword).
2112
2113 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2114 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2115 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2116 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2117 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2118 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2119 of the stick-table name as follows:
2120
2121 peers mypeers
2122 peer A ...
2123 peer B ...
2124 table t1 ...
2125
2126 frontend fe1
2127 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2128
2129 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2130 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2131
2132 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2133 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2134 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2135 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2136 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2137 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2138 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2139
2140 peers mypeers
2141 peer A ...
2142 peer B ...
2143 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2144
2145 backend t1
2146 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2147
2148 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2149 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2150 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2151
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090021523.6. Mailers
2153------------
2154It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2155If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2156in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2157
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002158mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002159 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2160 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2161
2162mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2163 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2164
2165 Example:
2166 mailers mymailers
2167 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2168 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2169
2170 backend mybackend
2171 mode tcp
2172 balance roundrobin
2173
2174 email-alert mailers mymailers
2175 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2176 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2177
2178 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2179 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2180
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002181timeout mail <time>
2182 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2183 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2184 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2185 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2186
2187 Example:
2188 mailers mymailers
2189 timeout mail 20s
2190 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002191
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020021923.7. Programs
2193-------------
2194In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2195master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2196managed the same way as the workers.
2197
2198During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2199sequence as a worker:
2200
2201 - the master is re-executed
2202 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2203 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2204 instance of the program
2205
2206During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2207
2208program <name>
2209 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2210 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2211 the management guide).
2212
2213command <command> [arguments*]
2214 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2215 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2216 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2217 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2218
2219option start-on-reload
2220no option start-on-reload
2221 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2222 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2223 program section.
2224
2225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022264. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002227----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002228
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002229Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002230 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002231 - frontend <name>
2232 - backend <name>
2233 - listen <name>
2234
2235A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2236its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2237section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002238section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002239
2240A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2241connections.
2242
2243A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2244to forward incoming connections.
2245
2246A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2247parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2248
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002249All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2250'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2251case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2252
2253Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2254logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2255proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2256However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2257name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2258
2259Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2260and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002261bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002262protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2263modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2264arbitrary criteria.
2265
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002266In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2267a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002268the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002269
2270 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2271 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2272 between responses and new requests.
2273
2274 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2275 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2276 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002277 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2278 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2279 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2280 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002281
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002282 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2283 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2284 client-facing connection remains open.
2285
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002286 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2287 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002288
2289The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2290frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2291following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002292weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002293
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002294 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002295
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002296 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2297 ----+-----+-----+----
2298 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2299 ----+-----+-----+----
2300 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2301 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2302 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2303 ----+-----+-----+----
2304 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002305
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002306
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023084.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2309--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002311The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2312limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2313they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2314limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002315marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002316option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002317and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2318with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2319specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002321
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002322 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2323------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2324acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002325backlog X X X -
2326balance X - X X
2327bind - X X -
2328bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002329block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002330capture cookie - X X -
2331capture request header - X X -
2332capture response header - X X -
2333clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002334compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002335contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2336cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002337declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002338default-server X - X X
2339default_backend X X X -
2340description - X X X
2341disabled X X X X
2342dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002343email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002344email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002345email-alert mailers X X X X
2346email-alert myhostname X X X X
2347email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002348enabled X X X X
2349errorfile X X X X
2350errorloc X X X X
2351errorloc302 X X X X
2352-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2353errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002354force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002355filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002356fullconn X - X X
2357grace X X X X
2358hash-type X - X X
2359http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002360http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002361http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002362http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002363http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002364http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002365http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002366id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002367ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002368load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002369log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002370log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002371log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002372log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002373max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002374maxconn X X X -
2375mode X X X X
2376monitor fail - X X -
2377monitor-net X X X -
2378monitor-uri X X X -
2379option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2380option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2381option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2382option allbackups (*) X - X X
2383option checkcache (*) X - X X
2384option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2385option contstats (*) X X X -
2386option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2387option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002388-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2389option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002390option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002391option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002392option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002393option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002394option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002395option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002396option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002397option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002398option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002399option httpchk X - X X
2400option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002401option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002402option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002403option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002404option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002405option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002406option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2407option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2408option logasap (*) X X X -
2409option mysql-check X - X X
2410option nolinger (*) X X X X
2411option originalto X X X X
2412option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002413option pgsql-check X - X X
2414option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002415option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002416option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002417option smtpchk X - X X
2418option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2419option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2420option splice-request (*) X X X X
2421option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002422option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002423option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2424option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2425-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002426option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002427option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2428option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2429option tcpka X X X X
2430option tcplog X X X X
2431option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002432external-check command X - X X
2433external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002434persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2435rate-limit sessions X X X -
2436redirect - X X X
2437redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2438redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002439reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2440reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2441reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2442reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2443reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2444reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2445reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2446reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2447reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2448reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2449reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2450reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002451-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002452reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002453retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002454retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002455rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2456rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2457rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2458rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2459rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2460rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2461rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002462server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002463server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002464server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002465source X - X X
2466srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002467stats admin - X X X
2468stats auth X X X X
2469stats enable X X X X
2470stats hide-version X X X X
2471stats http-request - X X X
2472stats realm X X X X
2473stats refresh X X X X
2474stats scope X X X X
2475stats show-desc X X X X
2476stats show-legends X X X X
2477stats show-node X X X X
2478stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002479-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2480stick match - - X X
2481stick on - - X X
2482stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002483stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002484stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002485tcp-check connect - - X X
2486tcp-check expect - - X X
2487tcp-check send - - X X
2488tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002489tcp-request connection - X X -
2490tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002491tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002492tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002493tcp-response content - - X X
2494tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002495timeout check X - X X
2496timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002497timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002498timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2499timeout connect X - X X
2500timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2501timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2502timeout http-request X X X X
2503timeout queue X - X X
2504timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002505timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002506timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2507timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002508timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002509transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002510unique-id-format X X X -
2511unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002512use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002513use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002514------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2515 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025184.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2519---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002520
2521This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2522
2523
2524acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2525 Declare or complete an access list.
2526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2527 no | yes | yes | yes
2528 Example:
2529 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2530 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2531 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002533 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002534
2535
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002536backlog <conns>
2537 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2539 yes | yes | yes | no
2540 Arguments :
2541 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2542 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002543 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002544
2545 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2546 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2547 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2548 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2549 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2550 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2551 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2552 backlog parameter.
2553
2554 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2555 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2556 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2557
2558 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2559
2560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002562balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002563 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2565 yes | no | yes | yes
2566 Arguments :
2567 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2568 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2569 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2570 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2571
2572 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2573 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2574 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2575 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002576 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002577 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002578 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2579 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2580 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2581 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2582 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2583 it, so that you don't worry.
2584
2585 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2586 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2587 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2588 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2589 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2590 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2591 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2592 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002593
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002594 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2595 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2596 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2597 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2598 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2599 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2600 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2601 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2602
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002603 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002604 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002605 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2606 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002607 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002608 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2609 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2610 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2611 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2612 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002613 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2614 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2615 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2616 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2617 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2618 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2621 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2622 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2623 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2624 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2625 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2626 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2627 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002628 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002629 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002630 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2631 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2632 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002633
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002634 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2635 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2636 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2637 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2638 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2639 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2640 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2641 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2642 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2643 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2644 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2645 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002646
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002647 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002648 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2649 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2650 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2651 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2652 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2653 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2654 URIs start with a leading "/".
2655
2656 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2657 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2658 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2659 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2660
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002661 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002662 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2663
2664 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002665 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2666 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002667 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2668 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2669 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2670 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002671 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002672 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2673 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002674
2675 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2676 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2677 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2678 server will receive the request.
2679
2680 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2681 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2682 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2683 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2684 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002685 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2686 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2687 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002688
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002689 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2690 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2691 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2692 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2693 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002695 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002696 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2697 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2698 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2699
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002700 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2701 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2702 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2703
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002704 random
2705 random(<draws>)
2706 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002707 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2708 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2709 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2710 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002711 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2712 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2713 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2714 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2715 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2716 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2717 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2718 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2719 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2720 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2721 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2722 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2723 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2724 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2725 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2726 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2727 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2728 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2729 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2730 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002731
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002732 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002733 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002734 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2735 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2736 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2737 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2738 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2739 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002740 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002741 used instead.
2742
2743 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2744 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2745 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2746 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2747
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002748 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2749 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2750 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2751
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002752 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002754 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002755 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2756 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002757
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002758 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2759 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2760 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002762 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2763 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2764 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2765 NTLM relies on.
2766
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002767 Examples :
2768 balance roundrobin
2769 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002770 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002771 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2772 balance hdr(host)
2773 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002774
2775 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2776 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002778 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002779 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2780 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2781 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2782 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2783
2784 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2785 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2786 defaults to 16 kB.
2787
2788 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2789 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2790
2791 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2792 Round Robin.
2793
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002794 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002795 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2796 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2797 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2798
2799 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2800
2801 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002802 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002803 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2804 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2805 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002806
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002807 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808
2809
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002810bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2811bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002812 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2814 no | yes | yes | no
2815 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002816 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2817 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2818 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2819 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002820 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002821 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2822 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2823 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2824 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2825 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2826 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2827 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002828 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2829 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2830 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2831 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2832 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2833 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2834 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002835 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2836 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2837 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002838 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2839 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2840 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2841 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002842 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2843 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2844 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002845
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002846 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2847 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002848 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2849 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2850 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002851 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2852 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2853 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2854 the range.
2855
2856 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2857 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2858 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2859 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2860 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2861 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2862 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002863 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002864 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002865
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002866 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002867 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002868 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2869 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2870 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2871 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2872 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2873 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2874
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002875 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2876 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2877 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2878 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002880 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2881 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2882 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2883 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2884 in a frontend.
2885
2886 Example :
2887 listen http_proxy
2888 bind :80,:443
2889 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002890 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002892 listen http_https_proxy
2893 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002894 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002895
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002896 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2897 bind ipv6@:80
2898 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2899 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2900
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002901 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002902 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002903
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002904 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2905 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2906 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2907 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2908 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2909
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002910 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002911 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912
2913
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002914bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002915 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2917 yes | yes | yes | yes
2918 Arguments :
2919 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2920 may be used to override a default value.
2921
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002922 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002923 option may be combined with other numbers.
2924
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002925 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002926 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2927 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2928 missing from all processes.
2929
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002930 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002931 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002932 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2933 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2934 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2935 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2936 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002937 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002938
2939 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2940 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2941 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2942 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2943 and 'even' instances.
2944
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002945 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2946 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2947 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2948 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002949
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002950 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2951 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2952
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002953 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2954 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2955 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2956
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002957 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2958 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2959
2960 Example :
2961 listen app_ip1
2962 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002963 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002964
2965 listen app_ip2
2966 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002967 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002968
2969 listen management
2970 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002971 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002972
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002973 listen management
2974 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2975 bind-process 1-4
2976
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002977 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002978
2979
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002980block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002981 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 no | yes | yes | yes
2984
2985 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2986 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002987 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002988 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002989 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002990 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2991 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2992 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002993
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002994 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2995 "http-request deny" instead.
2996
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997 Example:
2998 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2999 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3000 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003001 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3002 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3003 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003004
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003005 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3006 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3007 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003008
3009capture cookie <name> len <length>
3010 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3012 no | yes | yes | no
3013 Arguments :
3014 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3015 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3016 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3017 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003018 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003019
3020 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3021 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3022 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3023 right if it exceeds <length>.
3024
3025 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3026 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3027 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3028 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3029
3030 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3031 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3032 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3033
3034 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3035 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3036 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003037 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3038 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3039 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040
3041 Example:
3042 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3043
3044 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003045 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003046
3047
3048capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003049 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3051 no | yes | yes | no
3052 Arguments :
3053 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003054 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3056 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3057 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3058
3059 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3060 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3061 it exceeds <length>.
3062
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003063 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003064 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3065 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003066 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3067 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3068 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3069 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003070 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003071 environments to find where the request came from.
3072
3073 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3074 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3075 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3076 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003078 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3079 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3080 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3081 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3082 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083
3084 Example:
3085 capture request header Host len 15
3086 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003087 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003089 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090 about logging.
3091
3092
3093capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003094 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3096 no | yes | yes | no
3097 Arguments :
3098 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003099 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003100 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3101 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3102 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3103
3104 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3105 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3106 it exceeds <length>.
3107
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003108 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003109 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3110 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3111 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003112 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3113 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3114 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3115 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003117 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3118 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3119 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3120 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3121 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122
3123 Example:
3124 capture response header Content-length len 9
3125 capture response header Location len 15
3126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003127 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128 about logging.
3129
3130
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003131clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003132 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3134 yes | yes | yes | no
3135 Arguments :
3136 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3137 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3138 as explained at the top of this document.
3139
3140 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3141 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3142 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3143 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3144 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3145 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3146 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3147 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003148 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003149 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003150 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151
3152 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3153 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3154 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3155 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3156 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3157 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3158
3159 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3160 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3161
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003162 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3163 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003165compression algo <algorithm> ...
3166compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003167compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003168 Enable HTTP compression.
3169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 yes | yes | yes | yes
3171 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003172 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3173 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3174 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3175
3176 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003177 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3178 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3179 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003180
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003181 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003182 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003183
3184 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3185 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3186 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3187 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3188 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003189 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003190
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003191 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3192 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3193 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3194 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3195 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3196 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3197 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003198 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003199
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003200 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003201 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003202 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3203 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3204 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3205 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3206 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003207
3208 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3209 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3210 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3211 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3212 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003213 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3214 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3215 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3216 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3217 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003218 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3219 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003220
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003221 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003222 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3223 "Accept-Encoding" header
3224 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003225 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003226 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3227 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3228 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3229 "multipart"
3230 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3231 header
3232 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3233 and later
3234 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3235 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003236 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003237
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003238 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003239
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003240 Examples :
3241 compression algo gzip
3242 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003243
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003244
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003245contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003246 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3248 yes | no | yes | yes
3249 Arguments :
3250 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3251 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3252 as explained at the top of this document.
3253
3254 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003255 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003256 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003257 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003258 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3259 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3260 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3261
3262 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3263 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3264 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3265 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3266 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3267 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3268
3269 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3270 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3271 instead.
3272
3273 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3274 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3275
3276
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003277cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003278 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3279 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003280 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003281 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3283 yes | no | yes | yes
3284 Arguments :
3285 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3286 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3287 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3288 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3289 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3290 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003291 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003292 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3293 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3294
3295 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3296 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3297 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3298 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3299 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3300 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003301 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3302 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003303 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003304 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3305 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306
3307 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003308 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003309
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003310 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003311 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003312 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003313 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003314 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3315 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3316 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3317 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3318 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3319 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3320 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003321
3322 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3323 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3324 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3325 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3326 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3327 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3328 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3329 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3330 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003331 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003332 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3333 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3334 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003335
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003336 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3337 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3338 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003339 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3340 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3341 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3342 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003343 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3344 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3345 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003346
3347 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3348 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3349 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3350 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3351 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3352 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3353 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3354 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3355 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3356
3357 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3358 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3359 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3360 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3361 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3362 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3363 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3364 persistence cookie in the cache.
3365 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3366
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003367 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3368 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3369 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3370 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3371 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003372 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003373 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3374 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3375 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3376 they logout.
3377
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003378 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3379 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3380 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3381 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3382
3383 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3384 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3385 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3386 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3387 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3388 this attribute.
3389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003390 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003391 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003392 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3393 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3394 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3395 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3396 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3397 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003398
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003399 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3400 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3401 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3402 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3403 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3404 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3405 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3406 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003407 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003408 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3409 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3410 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3411 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3412 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3413 the site.
3414
3415 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3416 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3417 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3418 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3419 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3420 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3421 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3422 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3423 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3424 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3425 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3426 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3427 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003428 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003429 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3430 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3431
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003432 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3433 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3434 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3435 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3436 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3437 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003439 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3440 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3441 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3442 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003444 Examples :
3445 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3446 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3447 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003448 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003449
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003450 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003451
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003452
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003453declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3454 Declares a capture slot.
3455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3456 no | yes | yes | no
3457 Arguments:
3458 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3459
3460 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3461 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3462 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3463 for use in the response.
3464
3465 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003466 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003467 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3468
3469
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003470default-server [param*]
3471 Change default options for a server in a backend
3472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3473 yes | no | yes | yes
3474 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003475 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3476 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3477 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3478 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003479
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003480 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003481 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3482
3483 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003484
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003485
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003486default_backend <backend>
3487 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3489 yes | yes | yes | no
3490 Arguments :
3491 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3492
3493 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3494 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3495 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3496 will catch all undetermined requests.
3497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003498 Example :
3499
3500 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3501 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3502 default_backend dynamic
3503
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003504 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003506
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003507description <string>
3508 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3510 no | yes | yes | yes
3511 Arguments : string
3512
3513 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3514 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3515 it describes.
3516 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3517
3518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519disabled
3520 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3522 yes | yes | yes | yes
3523 Arguments : none
3524
3525 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3526 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3527 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3528 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3529 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3530 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3531 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3532
3533 See also : "enabled"
3534
3535
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003536dispatch <address>:<port>
3537 Set a default server address
3538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3539 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003540 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003541
3542 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3543 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3544 during start-up.
3545
3546 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3547 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3548 possible with normal servers.
3549
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003550 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003551 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3552 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3553 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3554 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3555
3556 See also : "server"
3557
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003558
3559dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3560 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3562 yes | no | yes | yes
3563 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3564
3565 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003566 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003567 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3568 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003569 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003570 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003571
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003572enabled
3573 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3575 yes | yes | yes | yes
3576 Arguments : none
3577
3578 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3579 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3580
3581 See also : "disabled"
3582
3583
3584errorfile <code> <file>
3585 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3587 yes | yes | yes | yes
3588 Arguments :
3589 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003590 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3591 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003592
3593 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003594 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003595 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003596 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3597 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598
3599 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3600 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3601 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3602
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003603 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003605 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3606 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3607 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3608 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3609
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003610 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3611 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003612 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003613 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3614 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3615 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3616
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003617 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3618 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3619 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003620 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3622
3623 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3624
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003625 Example :
3626 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003627 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003628 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3629 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3630
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003631
3632errorloc <code> <url>
3633errorloc302 <code> <url>
3634 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3636 yes | yes | yes | yes
3637 Arguments :
3638 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003639 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3640 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003641
3642 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3643 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3644 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3645 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003646 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003647
3648 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3649 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3650 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3651
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003652 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3653
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003654 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3655 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3656 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3657 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003658 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003659 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3660 request.
3661
3662 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3663
3664
3665errorloc303 <code> <url>
3666 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 yes | yes | yes | yes
3669 Arguments :
3670 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003671 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3672 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003673
3674 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3675 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3676 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3677 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003678 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003679
3680 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3681 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3682 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3683
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003684 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3685
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003686 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3687 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3688 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3689 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003690 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003691
3692 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3693
3694
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003695email-alert from <emailaddr>
3696 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003697 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003698 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3699 yes | yes | yes | yes
3700
3701 Arguments :
3702
3703 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3704
3705 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3706 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3707
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003708 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003709 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3710 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003711
3712
3713email-alert level <level>
3714 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3715 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3716 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3717 yes | yes | yes | yes
3718
3719 Arguments :
3720
3721 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3722 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3723 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3724
3725 By default level is alert
3726
3727 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3728 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3729 for the proxy.
3730
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003731 Alerts are sent when :
3732
3733 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3734 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3735 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3736 is notice or lower
3737 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3738 and a health check status update occurs
3739
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003740 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3741 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003742 section 3.6 about mailers.
3743
3744
3745email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3746 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3748 yes | yes | yes | yes
3749
3750 Arguments :
3751
3752 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3753
3754 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3755 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3756
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003757 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3758 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003759
3760
3761email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3762 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3763 mailers.
3764 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | yes | yes | yes
3766
3767 Arguments :
3768
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003769 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003770
3771 By default the systems hostname is used.
3772
3773 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3774 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3775 for the proxy.
3776
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003777 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3778 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003779
3780
3781email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003782 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003783 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3785 yes | yes | yes | yes
3786
3787 Arguments :
3788
3789 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3790
3791 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3792 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3793
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003794 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003795 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3796
3797
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003798force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3799 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003801 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003802
3803 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3804 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3805 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3806 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3807 marked down for maintenance operations.
3808
3809 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3810 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3811 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3812 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3813 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3814 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3815 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3816 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3817 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3818
3819 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3820 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3821 is used.
3822
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003823 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003824 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003825
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003826
3827filter <name> [param*]
3828 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3830 no | yes | yes | yes
3831 Arguments :
3832 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3833 referenced in section 9.
3834
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003835 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003836 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003837 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3838 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003839
3840 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3841 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3842
3843 Example:
3844 listen
3845 bind *:80
3846
3847 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3848 filter compression
3849 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3850
3851 compression algo gzip
3852 compression offload
3853
3854 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3855
3856 See also : section 9.
3857
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003858
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003859fullconn <conns>
3860 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3862 yes | no | yes | yes
3863 Arguments :
3864 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3865 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3866
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003867 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003868 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003869 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003870 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3871 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3872 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3873 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3874 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003875 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003876
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003877 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3878 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003879 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3880 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3881 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003882
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003883 Example :
3884 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3885 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3886 # connections.
3887 backend dynamic
3888 fullconn 10000
3889 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3890 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3891
3892 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3893
3894
3895grace <time>
3896 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003898 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003899 Arguments :
3900 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3901 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3902 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3903
3904 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3905 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003906 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003907 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3908
3909 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3910 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3911 simplify it.
3912
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003913
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003914hash-balance-factor <factor>
3915 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3917 yes | no | no | yes
3918 Arguments :
3919 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3920 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003921 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003922
3923 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3924 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3925 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3926 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3927 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3928 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3929 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3930
3931 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3932 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3933 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3934 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3935 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3936
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003937 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3938 consistent hashing mechanism.
3939
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003940 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3941
3942
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003943hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003944 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3946 yes | no | yes | yes
3947 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003948 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3949 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003950
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003951 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3952 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3953 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3954 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3955 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3956 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3957 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3958 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3959 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3960 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003961
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003962 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3963 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3964 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3965 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3966 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3967 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3968 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3969 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3970 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3971 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3972 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3973 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3974 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003975 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3976 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003977
3978 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3979
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003980 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003981 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3982 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3983 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003984 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3985 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3986 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003987
3988 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3989 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003990 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3991 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3992 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3993 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3994
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003995 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3996 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3997 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3998 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3999 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4000 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4001 parameter.
4002
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004003 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4004 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4005 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4006 used on strings.
4007
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004008 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4009
4010 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4011 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4012 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4013 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4014 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4015 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4016 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4017 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4018 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4019 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4020 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4021 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004022
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004023 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4024 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4025 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004026
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004027 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004028
4029
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004030http-check disable-on-404
4031 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004033 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004034 Arguments : none
4035
4036 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4037 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4038 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4039 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4040 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4041 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4042 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4043 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004044 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4045 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4046 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4047
4048 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4049
4050
4051http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004052 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004054 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004055 Arguments :
4056 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4057 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004058 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004059 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4060 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4061 details on the supported keywords.
4062
4063 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4064 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4065 with the usual backslash ('\').
4066
4067 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4068 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4069 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4070 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4071 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4072
4073 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004074 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004075 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4076 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4077 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4078
4079 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004080 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004081 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4082 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4083 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4084 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4085
4086 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004087 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004088 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4089 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4090 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4091 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4092 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004093 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004094 trace).
4095
4096 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004097 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004098 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4099 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4100 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4101 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4102 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004103 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004104
4105 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4106 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4107 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4108 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4109 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4110 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4111 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4112 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4113
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004114 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4115 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4116 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4117
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004118 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4119 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4120
4121 Examples :
4122 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004123 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004124
4125 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004126 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004127
4128 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004129 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004130
4131 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004132 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004133
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004134 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004135
4136
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004137http-check send-state
4138 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4140 yes | no | yes | yes
4141 Arguments : none
4142
4143 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4144 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4145 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4146 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4147 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4148
4149 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4150 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4151 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4152 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4153 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004154 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4155 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4156 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4157
4158 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4159 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4160 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4161
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004162 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4163 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4164 checked in multiple backends.
4165
4166 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4167 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4168
4169 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4170 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4171 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4172 one fails.
4173
4174 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4175 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4176 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4177
4178 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4179 server's queue.
4180
4181 Example of a header received by the application server :
4182 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4183 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4184
4185 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004187
4188http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004189 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4190
4191 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 no | yes | yes | yes
4193
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004194 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4195 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4196 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4197 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4198 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004200 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4201 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004203 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004205 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4206 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4207 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4208 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004210 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4211 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4212 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4213 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004215 Example:
4216 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4217 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4218 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004220 http-request allow if nagios
4221 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4222 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4223 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 Example:
4226 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4227 acl add path /addacl
4228 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004230 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004232 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4233 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004235 Example:
4236 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4237 acl setmap path /setmap
4238 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004240 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4243 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004245 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4246 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004250 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4251 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4252 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4253 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4254 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4255 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4256 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4257 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004261 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4262 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4263 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4264 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4265 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4266 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4267 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4268 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004270http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004272 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4273 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004274
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004276http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4279 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4280 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4281 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4282 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 Example:
4285 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4286 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004287
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004288http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004290 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4293 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004295 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4296 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4297 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4298 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4299 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4300 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4301 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4302 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4303 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4306 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4307 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4308 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4309 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4310 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004312http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004314 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4315 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4316 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4317 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4318 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4319 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004323 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4328 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4329 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4330 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4331 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4332 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004334http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004336 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4337 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4338 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4339 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4340 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004341
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004342http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4343 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4344 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4345 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4346
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004347http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4348
4349 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4350 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4351 pointed by <resolvers>.
4352 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4353 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4354 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4355 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4356 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4357 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4358 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4359 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4360 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4361 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4362 to 0.0.0.0.
4363
4364 Example:
4365 resolvers mydns
4366 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4367 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4368 timeout retry 1s
4369 hold valid 10s
4370 hold nx 3s
4371 hold other 3s
4372 hold obsolete 0s
4373 accepted_payload_size 8192
4374
4375 frontend fe
4376 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4377 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4378 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4379
4380 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4381 # which mean DNS resolution error
4382 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4383
4384 default_backend be
4385
4386 backend b_503
4387 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4388 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4389 # 503 error page to end users
4390
4391 backend be
4392 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4393 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4394 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4395 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4396 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4397
4398 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4399 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4400
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004401http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4402
4403 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4404 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4405 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4406 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004407 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4408 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004409
4410 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004412http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004414 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4415 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4416 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4417 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4418 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004420http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004422 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4423 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4424 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4425 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004427http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4428 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004430 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4431 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4432 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4433 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4434 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4435 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4436 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4437 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004439 Example:
4440 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004442 # applied to:
4443 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004445 # outputs:
4446 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004448 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004449
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004450http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4451 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4452
4453 This matches the regular expression in the URI part of the request
4454 according to <match-regex>, and replaces it with the <replace-fmt>
4455 argument. Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a
4456 number are supported. The <fmt> field is interpreted as a log-format string
4457 so it may contain special expressions just like the <fmt> argument passed
4458 to "http-request set-uri". The match is exclusively case-sensitive. Any
4459 optional scheme, authority or query string are considered in the matching
4460 part of the URI. It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more
4461 expensive to evaluate than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit
4462 from a condition to avoid performing the evaluation at all if it does not
4463 match.
4464
4465 Example:
4466 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4467 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
4468
4469 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4470 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4471
4472 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4473 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4474 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4475 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4476
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004477http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4478 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004479
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004480 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4481 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4482 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4483 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004484
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004485 Example:
4486 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004487
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004488 # applied to:
4489 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004490
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004491 # outputs:
4492 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004494http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4495http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004497 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4498 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4499 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004502
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004503 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4504 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4505 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004507http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004509 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4510 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4511 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4512 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4513 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004514
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004515 Arguments:
4516 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4517 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004518
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004519 Example:
4520 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4521 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004523 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4524 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004526http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004528 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4529 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4530 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004531
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004532 Arguments:
4533 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4534 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536 Example:
4537 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4538 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004540 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4541 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4542 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004544http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004546 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4547 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4548 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4549 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4550 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004552 Example:
4553 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4554 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4555 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4556 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4557 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4558 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4559 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4560 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4561 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004563http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004564
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004565 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4566 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4567 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4568 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4569 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004571http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4572 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004574 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4575 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4576 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4577 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4578 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4579 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4580 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4581 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4582 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004584http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4587 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4588 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4589 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4590 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4591 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4592 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004594http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004596 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4597 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4598 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004600http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004602 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4603 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4604 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4605 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4606 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4607 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4608 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4609 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004611http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004613 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4614 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4615 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4616 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4617 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4618 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004620 Example :
4621 # prepend the host name before the path
4622 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004624http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004626 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4627 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4628 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4629 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4630 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004632http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004634 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4635 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4636 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4637 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4638 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4639 values have higher priority.
4640 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4641 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4642 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4643 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4644 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004646http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004648 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4649 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4650 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4651 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4652 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4653 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4654 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004656 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004657
4658 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004659 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4660 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004662http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4663 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4664 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4665 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4666 privacy.
4667
4668 Arguments :
4669 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4670 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004671
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004672 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004673 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4674 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4675
4676 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4677 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4678
4679http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4680
4681 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4682 expression.
4683
4684 Arguments:
4685 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4686 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004687
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004688 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004689 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4690 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4691
4692 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4693 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4694 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4695
4696http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4697
4698 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4699 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4700 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4701 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4702 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4703 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4704 information from the request.
4705
4706 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4707
4708http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4709
4710 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4711 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4712 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4713 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4714 path and the query string.
4715 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4716
4717http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4718
4719 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4720 inline.
4721
4722 Arguments:
4723 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4724 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4725 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4726 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4727 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4728 (request and response)
4729 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4730 processing
4731 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4732 processing
4733 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4734 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4735 and '_'.
4736
4737 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4738 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004739
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004740 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004741 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004743http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4744 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004746 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4747 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4748 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4749 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4750 agent name must be used.
4751
4752 Arguments:
4753 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4754
4755 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4756 configuration.
4757
4758http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4759
4760 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4761 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4762 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4763 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4764 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4765 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4766 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4767 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4768 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4769 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4770 action.
4771 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4772 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4773 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4774 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4775 you fully understand how it works.
4776
4777http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4778
4779 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4780 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4781 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4782 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4783 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4784 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4785 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4786 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4787 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4788 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4789 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4790 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4791 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4792
4793http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4794http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4795http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4796
4797 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4798 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4799 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4800 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4801 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4802 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4803 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4804 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4805 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4806 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4807 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4808 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4809
4810 Arguments :
4811 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4812 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4813 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4814 select which table entry to update the counters.
4815
4816 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4817 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4818 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4819 that table until the session ends.
4820
4821 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4822 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4823 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4824 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4825 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4826 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4827 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4828 useful information.
4829
4830 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4831 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4832 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4833 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4834 checks that make use of it.
4835
4836http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4837
4838 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004839
4840 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004841 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004842
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004843http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004845 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4846 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4847 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004848
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004849
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004850http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004851 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4852
4853 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4854 no | yes | yes | yes
4855
4856 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4857 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4858 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4859 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4860 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4861 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004863 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4864 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004865
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004866 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004867
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004868 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4869 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4870 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4871 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004872
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004873 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4874 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4875 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4876 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004877
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004878 Example:
4879 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004881 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4884 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004886 Example:
4887 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004888
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004889 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004890
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004891 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4892 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004893
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004894 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4895 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004896
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004897http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004898
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004899 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4900 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4901 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4902 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4903 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4904 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4905 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4906 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004908http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004910 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4911 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4912 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4913 example, or to pass some internal information.
4914 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4915 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4916 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004917
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004918http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004920 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4921 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004922
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004923http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004925 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004926
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004927http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004928
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004929 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4930 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4931 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4932 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4933 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4934 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4935 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004937 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4938 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4939 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4940 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4941 keyword.
4942 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4943 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004945http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004947 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4948 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4949 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4950 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4951 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4952 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004956 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004958http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004960 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4961 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4962 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4963 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4964 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4965 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004967http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004968
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004969 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4970 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004972http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004974 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4975 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4976 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4977 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4978 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4979 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004981http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4982 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004984 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4985 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4986 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4987 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4988 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4989 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4990 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4991 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004993 Example:
4994 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004995
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004996 # applied to:
4997 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004998
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004999 # outputs:
5000 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005001
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005002 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005003
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005004http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5005 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005007 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5008 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
5009 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
5010 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005011
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005012 Example:
5013 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005015 # applied to:
5016 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005018 # outputs:
5019 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005021http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5022http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005024 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5025 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5026 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005028http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005030 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5031 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5032 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5037 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5038 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5039 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5040 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005042 Arguments:
5043 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005045 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5046 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005048http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005050 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5051 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5052 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005054http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5055
5056 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5057 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5058 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5059 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5060 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5061
5062http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5063
5064 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5065 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5066 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5067 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5068 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5069 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5070 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5071 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5072 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5073
5074http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5075
5076 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5077 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5078 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5079 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5080 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5081 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5082 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5083
5084http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5085
5086 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5087 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5088 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5089 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5090 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5091 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5092 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5093 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5094
5095http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5096 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5097
5098 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5099 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5100 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5101 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005102
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005103 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005104 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5105 http-response set-status 431
5106 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5107 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005108
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005109http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005111 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5112 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5113 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5114 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5115 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5116 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5117 based on some information from the request.
5118
5119 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5120
5121http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5122
5123 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5124 inline.
5125
5126 Arguments:
5127 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5128 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5129 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5130 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5131 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5132 (request and response)
5133 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5134 processing
5135 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5136 processing
5137 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5138 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5139 and '_'.
5140
5141 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5142 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005143
5144 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005145 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005146
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005147http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005148
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005149 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5150 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5151 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5152 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5153 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5154 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5155 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5156 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5157 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5158 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5159 action.
5160 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5161 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5162 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5163 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5164 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005165
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005166http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5167http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5168http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005170 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5171 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5172 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5173 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5174 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5175 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5176
5177http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5178
5179 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5180 about <var-name>.
5181
5182 Example:
5183 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5184
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005185
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005186http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5187 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5188
5189 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5190 yes | no | yes | yes
5191
5192 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005193 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5194 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5195 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005196
5197 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5198
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005199 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5200 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5201 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5202 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5203 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5204 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5205 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5206 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5207 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5208 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005209
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005210 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5211 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5212 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5213 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5214 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5215 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5216 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5217 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005218
5219 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5220 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5221 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5222 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5223 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5224 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5225 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5226 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005227 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005228 downsides of rare connection failures.
5229
5230 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5231 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5232 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5233 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5234 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5235 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005236 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005237 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5238 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5239 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5240 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5241 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5242
5243 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005244 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5245 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5246 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005247
5248 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005249 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005250
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005251 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5252 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005253
5254 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5255 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5256 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5257
5258 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5259 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5260 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5261
5262 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5263
5264
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005265http-send-name-header [<header>]
5266 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5267
5268 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5269 yes | no | yes | yes
5270
5271 Arguments :
5272
5273 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5274
5275 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005276 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005277 is added with the header string proved.
5278
5279 See also : "server"
5280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005281id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005282 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5284 no | yes | yes | yes
5285 Arguments : none
5286
5287 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5288 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5289 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005290
5291
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005292ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5293 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5294 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005295 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005296
5297 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5298 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5299 and running).
5300
5301 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5302 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5303 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005304 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005305 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5306
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005307 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5308 "unless" condition is met.
5309
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005310 Example:
5311 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5312 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5313 ignore-persist if url_static
5314
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005315 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5316
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005317load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5318 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5320 yes | no | yes | yes
5321
5322 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5323 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5324 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005325 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005326 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5327 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5328 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5329 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5330
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005331 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005332 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005333 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005334
5335 Arguments:
5336 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5337 named "server-state-file".
5338
5339 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5340 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5341 name is used as a file name.
5342
5343 none don't load any stat for this backend
5344
5345 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005346 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5347 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5348 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005349 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005350 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005351
5352 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5353 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5354
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005355 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005356
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005357 global
5358 stats socket /tmp/socket
5359 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005360
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005361 defaults
5362 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005363
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005364 backend bk
5365 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5366 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005367
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005368
5369 Then one can run :
5370
5371 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5372
5373 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5374
5375 1
5376 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5377 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5378 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5379
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005380 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005381
5382 global
5383 stats socket /tmp/socket
5384 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5385
5386 defaults
5387 load-server-state-from-file local
5388
5389 backend bk
5390 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5391 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5392
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005393
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005394 Then one can run :
5395
5396 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5397
5398 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5399
5400 1
5401 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5402 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5403 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5404
5405 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5406 "show servers state"
5407
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005408
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005409log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005410log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5411 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005412no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005413 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5415 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005416
5417 Prefix :
5418 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5419 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5420 prefix does not allow arguments.
5421
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005422 Arguments :
5423 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5424 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5425 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5426 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5427 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5428 parameter.
5429
5430 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5431 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5432
5433 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5434 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5435 standard syslog port).
5436
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005437 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5438 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5439 standard syslog port).
5440
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005441 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5442 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5443 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005444 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005445
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005446 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5447 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5448 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5449 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5450 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5451 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5452 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5453 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5454 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5455 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5456 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5457 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5458 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5459 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5460 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5461 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005462 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5463 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005464
5465 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5466 and "fd@2", see above.
5467
5468 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5469 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005470
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005471 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5472 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5473 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5474 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5475 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5476 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5477 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5478 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5479 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5480 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005481 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005482
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005483 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5484 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5485 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5486 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5487 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5488
5489 <sample_size>
5490 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5491 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5492 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5493 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5494 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5495
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005496 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5497 one of the following :
5498
5499 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5500 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5501
5502 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5503 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5504
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005505 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5506 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5507 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5508 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5509 systemd logger consumes.
5510
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005511 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5512 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5513 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5514 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5515
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005516 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5517
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005518 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5519 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5520 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5521
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005522 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5523 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5524 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5525 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005526
5527 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5528 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5529 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005530 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5531 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5532 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5533 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5534 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005535
5536 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5537
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005538 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5539 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5540 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005541
5542 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5543 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5544 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5545 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5546
5547 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5548 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005549
5550 Example :
5551 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005552 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5553 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5554 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005555 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5556 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005557 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005558
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005559
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005560log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005561 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5562 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5563 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005564
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005565 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5566 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5567 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5568 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5569 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005570
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005571 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5572 "option httplog" directives.
5573
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005574log-format-sd <string>
5575 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5577 yes | yes | yes | no
5578
5579 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5580 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5581 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5582 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5583 which covers the log format string in depth.
5584
5585 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5586 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5587
5588 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5589 log format to "rfc5424".
5590
5591 Example :
5592 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5593
5594
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005595log-tag <string>
5596 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5597 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5598 yes | yes | yes | yes
5599
5600 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5601 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5602 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5603 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5604 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5605 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5606 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5607 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5608 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005609
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005610max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5611 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5612 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5613 yes | no | yes | yes
5614
5615 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5616 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5617 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5618 servers.
5619
5620 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5621 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5622 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5623 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5624 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005625 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005626 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5627 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5628 picking a different server.
5629
5630 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5631 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5632 even if they have to be queued.
5633
5634 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5635 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5636
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005637max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5638 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5639 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5640 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005641
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005642maxconn <conns>
5643 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5645 yes | yes | yes | no
5646 Arguments :
5647 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5648 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5649 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5650 closes.
5651
5652 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5653 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5654 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5655 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005656 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5657 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5658 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5659 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005660
5661 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5662 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5663 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5664
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005665 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5666 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005667
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005668 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5669
5670
5671mode { tcp|http|health }
5672 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5674 yes | yes | yes | yes
5675 Arguments :
5676 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5677 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5678 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5679 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5680
5681 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5682 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5683 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5684 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5685 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5686
5687 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005688 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5689 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5690 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5691 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5692 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5693 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5694 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005695
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005696 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5697 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5698 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005699
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005700 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005701 defaults http_instances
5702 mode http
5703
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005704 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005705
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005706
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005707monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005708 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5710 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005711 Arguments :
5712 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5713 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005714 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005715 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5716 backend and its backup.
5717
5718 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5719 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5720 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5721 servers in a list of backends.
5722
5723 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5724 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5725 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5726 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5727 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5728 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5729 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005730 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5731 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005732
5733 Example:
5734 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005735 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005736 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5737 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5738 monitor-uri /site_alive
5739 monitor fail if site_dead
5740
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005741 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005742
5743
5744monitor-net <source>
5745 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5747 yes | yes | yes | no
5748 Arguments :
5749 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5750 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5751 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5752 followed by a mask.
5753
5754 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5755 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005756 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005757 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5758
5759 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5760 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5761 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5762 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005763 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5764 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5765 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005766
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005767 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5768 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5769 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5770 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5771 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5772 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005773
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005774 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5775 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005776
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005777 Example :
5778 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5779 frontend www
5780 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5781
5782 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5783
5784
5785monitor-uri <uri>
5786 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5788 yes | yes | yes | no
5789 Arguments :
5790 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5791 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5792
5793 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5794 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5795 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5796 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5797 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5798 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5799 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5800 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5801
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005802 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5803 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5804 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5805 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5806 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5807 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5808 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5809 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005810
5811 Example :
5812 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5813 frontend www
5814 mode http
5815 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5816
5817 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005819
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005820option abortonclose
5821no option abortonclose
5822 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5824 yes | no | yes | yes
5825 Arguments : none
5826
5827 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5828 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5829 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5830 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005831 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005832 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5833 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5834 encountered while delivering the response.
5835
5836 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5837 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5838 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5839 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5840 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5841 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005842 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005843 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005844 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005845 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5846 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5847 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5848
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005849 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5850 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005851 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5852 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5853 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5854 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5855 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5856 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005857 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005858
5859 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5860 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5861
5862 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5863
5864
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005865option accept-invalid-http-request
5866no option accept-invalid-http-request
5867 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5869 yes | yes | yes | no
5870 Arguments : none
5871
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005872 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005873 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005874 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005875 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5876 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5877 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5878 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5879 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005880 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5881 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5882 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5883 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005884 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005885 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005886 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5887 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5888 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005889
5890 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5891 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5892 been confirmed.
5893
5894 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5895 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005896 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5897 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005898 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5899
5900 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5901 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5902
5903 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5904 stats socket.
5905
5906
5907option accept-invalid-http-response
5908no option accept-invalid-http-response
5909 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5911 yes | no | yes | yes
5912 Arguments : none
5913
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005914 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005915 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005916 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005917 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5918 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5919 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5920 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5921 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005922 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5923 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5924 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005925
5926 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5927 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5928 been confirmed.
5929
5930 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5931 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5932 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5933 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5934
5935 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5936 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5937
5938 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5939 stats socket.
5940
5941
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005942option allbackups
5943no option allbackups
5944 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5946 yes | no | yes | yes
5947 Arguments : none
5948
5949 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5950 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5951 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5952 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5953 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5954 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5955 order between the backup servers anymore.
5956
5957 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5958 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5959
5960 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5961 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5962
5963
5964option checkcache
5965no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005966 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5968 yes | no | yes | yes
5969 Arguments : none
5970
5971 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5972 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005973 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005974 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5975 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005976 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005977
5978 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005979 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005980 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005981 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5982 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005983 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005984 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005985 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5986 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005987 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005988 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5989 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005990 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005991 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5992 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5993 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5994 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5995 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5996 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5997 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5998 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5999 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6000
6001 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006002 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006003 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006004 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006005 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6006
6007 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6008 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006009 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006010 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006011
6012 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6013 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6014
6015
6016option clitcpka
6017no option clitcpka
6018 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6020 yes | yes | yes | no
6021 Arguments : none
6022
6023 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6024 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006025 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006026 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6027
6028 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6029 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6030 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6031 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6032
6033 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6034 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6035 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6036 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6037 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6038
6039 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6040
6041 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6042 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6043 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6044
6045 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6046 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6047
6048 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6049
6050
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006051option contstats
6052 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6054 yes | yes | yes | no
6055 Arguments : none
6056
6057 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6058 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6059 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6060 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006061 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6062 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6063 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6064 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6065 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006066
6067
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006068option dontlog-normal
6069no option dontlog-normal
6070 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6072 yes | yes | yes | no
6073 Arguments : none
6074
6075 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6076 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6077 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6078 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6079 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6080 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6081 logged.
6082
6083 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6084 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6085 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006087 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006088 logging.
6089
6090
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006091option dontlognull
6092no option dontlognull
6093 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6095 yes | yes | yes | no
6096 Arguments : none
6097
6098 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6099 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6100 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6101 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6102 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6103 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006104 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6105 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6106 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006107
6108 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006109 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006110 would not be logged.
6111
6112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6114
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006115 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6116 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006117
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006118
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006119option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006120 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6122 yes | yes | yes | yes
6123 Arguments :
6124 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6125 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006126 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006127 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006128
6129 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6130 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6131 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6132 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6133 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6134 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6135 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006136 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6137 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6138 possible that the client has already brought one.
6139
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006140 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006141 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006142 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006143 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006144 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006145 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006146
6147 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6148 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6149 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6150 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6151 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6152 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6153 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6154
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006155 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6156 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6157 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6158 are under the control of the end-user.
6159
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006160 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006161 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6162 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006163 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6164 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6165 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006166
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006167 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006168 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6169 frontend www
6170 mode http
6171 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6172
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006173 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6174 backend www
6175 mode http
6176 option forwardfor header X-Client
6177
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006178 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006179 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006180
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006181
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006182option http-buffer-request
6183no option http-buffer-request
6184 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6186 yes | yes | yes | yes
6187 Arguments : none
6188
6189 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6190 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6191 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6192 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6193 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6194 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6195 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6196 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006197 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006198 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6199 default.
6200
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006201 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006202
6203
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006204option http-ignore-probes
6205no option http-ignore-probes
6206 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6208 yes | yes | yes | no
6209 Arguments : none
6210
6211 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6212 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6213 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6214 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6215 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6216 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6217 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6218 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6219 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006220 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6221 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006222 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6223
6224 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6225 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6226 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6227 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6228 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6229 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6230 are often the only way to detect them.
6231
6232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6234
6235 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6236
6237
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006238option http-keep-alive
6239no option http-keep-alive
6240 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6242 yes | yes | yes | yes
6243 Arguments : none
6244
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006245 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6246 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006247 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6248 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6249 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6250 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6251 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006252
6253 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6254 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006255 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6256 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6257 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6258 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6259 situations where this option may be useful :
6260
6261 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006262 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006263
6264 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6265 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6266
6267 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6268 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6269 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6270 request.
6271
6272 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6273 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006274 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6275 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6276 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006277
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006278 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6279 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6280 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6281 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6282 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6283 not set.
6284
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006285 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006286 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6287 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006288
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006289 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006290 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006291 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006292
6293
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006294option http-no-delay
6295no option http-no-delay
6296 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6298 yes | yes | yes | yes
6299 Arguments : none
6300
6301 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6302 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6303 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6304 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6305 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6306 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6307 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6308 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6309 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6310 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6311 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6312 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6313 affected.
6314
6315 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6316 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6317 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6318 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6319 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6320 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6321 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6322 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6323 latency environments.
6324
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006325 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6326
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006327
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006328option http-pretend-keepalive
6329no option http-pretend-keepalive
6330 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006332 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006333 Arguments : none
6334
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006335 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006336 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6337 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6338 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6339 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6340 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6341 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6342 consider the response complete.
6343
6344 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6345 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6346 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6347 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006348 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006349 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6350
6351 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6352 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6353 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6354 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6355 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6356 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6357 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6358
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006359 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6360 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6361 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6362 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6363 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6364 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006365
6366 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6367 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6368
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006369 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006370 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006371
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006372
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006373option http-server-close
6374no option http-server-close
6375 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6377 yes | yes | yes | yes
6378 Arguments : none
6379
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006380 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6381 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6382 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6383 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006384 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6385 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6386 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6387 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6388 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6389 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6390 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6391 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6392 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6393 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6394 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006395
6396 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6397 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6398 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6399 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006400 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6401 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006402
6403 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6404 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006405 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6406 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6407 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006408
6409 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6410 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6411
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006412 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6413 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006414
6415
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006416option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6417no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6418 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006420 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006421 Arguments : none
6422
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006423 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6424 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6425 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6426
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006427 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6428 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6429 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6430 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006431 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006432
6433 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006434 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006435 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6436 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6437 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6438 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6439 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6440 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6441 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006442
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006443 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6444 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6445 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6446 backend.
6447
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6450
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006451 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6452 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006453
6454
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006455option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006456no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006457 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6459 yes | yes | yes | no
6460 Arguments : none
6461
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006462 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006463 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6464 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6465 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6466 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6467 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6468 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6469
6470 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6471 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006472 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6473 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6474 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006475
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006476 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6477 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6478 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6479 front of an existing proxy.
6480
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006481 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6482
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006483 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006484
6485
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006486option http-use-htx
6487no option http-use-htx
6488 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6490 yes | yes | yes | yes
6491 Arguments : none
6492
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006493 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006494 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006495 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6496 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6497 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6498 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6499 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006500
6501 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6502 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6503 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6504 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006505 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6506 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6507 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6508 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006509
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006510 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6511 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6512 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6513 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6514 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006515
6516 See also : "mode http"
6517
6518
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006519option httpchk
6520option httpchk <uri>
6521option httpchk <method> <uri>
6522option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6523 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6525 yes | no | yes | yes
6526 Arguments :
6527 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6528 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6529 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6530 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6531 ones.
6532
6533 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6534 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6535 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6536
6537 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6538 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6539 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6540 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6541 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6542
6543 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6544 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6545 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6546 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6547 the lack of any response.
6548
6549 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6550
6551 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6552 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6553 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6554
6555 Examples :
6556 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6557 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6558 backend https_relay
6559 mode tcp
6560 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6561 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6562
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006563 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6564 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6565 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006566
6567
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006568option httpclose
6569no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006570 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6572 yes | yes | yes | yes
6573 Arguments : none
6574
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006575 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6576 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6577 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6578 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006579 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006580
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006581 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6582 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6583 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6584 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6585 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006586
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006587 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6588 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6589 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006590
6591 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6592 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006593 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006594 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6595 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6596 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006597
6598 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6599 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6600
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006601 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006602
6603
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006604option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006605 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006607 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006608 Arguments :
6609 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6610 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6611 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006612 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006613 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006614
6615 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6616 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6617 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6618 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6619 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6620 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6621 ports.
6622
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006623 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6624 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006625
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006626 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006628 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006629
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006630
6631option http_proxy
6632no option http_proxy
6633 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6635 yes | yes | yes | yes
6636 Arguments : none
6637
6638 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6639 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6640 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6641 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6642 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6643
6644 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6645 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006646 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6647 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006648
6649 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6650 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6651
6652 Example :
6653 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6654 backend direct_forward
6655 option httpclose
6656 option http_proxy
6657
6658 See also : "option httpclose"
6659
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006660
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006661option independent-streams
6662no option independent-streams
6663 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6665 yes | yes | yes | yes
6666 Arguments : none
6667
6668 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6669 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6670 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6671 receive data or not.
6672
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006673 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006674 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6675 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6676 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6677 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6678 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6679 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6680 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6681 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6682 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6683 socket buffers.
6684
6685 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6686 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6687 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6688 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6689 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6690
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006691 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006692 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6693 deprecated.
6694
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006695 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006696
6697
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006698option ldap-check
6699 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6701 yes | no | yes | yes
6702 Arguments : none
6703
6704 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6705 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6706 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6707 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6708
6709 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6710 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6711
6712 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6713 configure it.
6714
6715 Example :
6716 option ldap-check
6717
6718 See also : "option httpchk"
6719
6720
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006721option external-check
6722 Use external processes for server health checks
6723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6724 yes | no | yes | yes
6725
6726 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6727 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6728 command".
6729
6730 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6731
6732 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6733
6734
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006735option log-health-checks
6736no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006737 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6739 yes | no | yes | yes
6740 Arguments : none
6741
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006742 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6743 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6744 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006745
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006746 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6747 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6748 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6749 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6750 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6751
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006752 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006753 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006754
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006755 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6756 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6757 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006758
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006759
6760option log-separate-errors
6761no option log-separate-errors
6762 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6764 yes | yes | yes | no
6765 Arguments : none
6766
6767 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6768 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6769 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6770 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6771 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6772 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6773 provides very important information.
6774
6775 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6776 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6777 error logs.
6778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006779 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006780 logging.
6781
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006782
6783option logasap
6784no option logasap
6785 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6787 yes | yes | yes | no
6788 Arguments : none
6789
6790 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6791 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6792 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6793 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6794 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6795 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6796 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006797 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006798 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6799 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6800
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006801 Examples :
6802 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6803 mode http
6804 option httplog
6805 option logasap
6806 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6807
6808 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6809 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6810 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6811 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006813 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006814 logging.
6815
6816
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006817option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006818 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6820 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006821 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006822 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6823 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006824 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006825
6826 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6827 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006828 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006829 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6830 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6831 in the MySQL table, like this :
6832
6833 USE mysql;
6834 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6835 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6836
6837 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006838 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006839 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6840 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6841 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6842 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6843 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6844 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6845 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6846
6847 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6848 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006849
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006850 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006851
6852 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6853 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6854 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6855 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006856 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6857 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006858
6859 See also: "option httpchk"
6860
6861
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006862option nolinger
6863no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006864 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006865 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6866 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006867 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006868
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006869 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006870 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6871 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6872 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6873 connections.
6874
6875 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6876 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6877 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6878 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6879 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6880 this too.
6881
6882 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6883 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6884 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6885
6886 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6887 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6888 for servers.
6889
6890 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6891 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6892
6893
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006894option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6895 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6897 yes | yes | yes | yes
6898 Arguments :
6899 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6900 matching <network>
6901 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6902 header name.
6903
6904 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6905 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6906 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6907 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6908 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6909 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6910 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6911 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6912 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6913 possible that the client has already brought one.
6914
6915 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6916 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6917 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6918 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6919 header and requires different one.
6920
6921 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6922 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6923 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6924 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6925 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6926 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6927 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6928
6929 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6930 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6931 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6932 both are defined.
6933
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006934 Examples :
6935 # Original Destination address
6936 frontend www
6937 mode http
6938 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6939
6940 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6941 backend www
6942 mode http
6943 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6944
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006945 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006946
6947
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006948option persist
6949no option persist
6950 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6951 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6952 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006953 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006954
6955 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6956 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6957 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6958 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6959 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6960 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6961 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6962 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6963 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6964 redirected to another valid server.
6965
6966 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6967 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6968
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006969 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006970
6971
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006972option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6973 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6975 yes | no | yes | yes
6976 Arguments :
6977 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6978 PostgreSQL server.
6979
6980 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6981 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6982 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6983 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6984
6985 See also: "option httpchk"
6986
6987
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006988option prefer-last-server
6989no option prefer-last-server
6990 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6992 yes | no | yes | yes
6993 Arguments : none
6994
6995 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6996 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6997 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6998 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6999 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7000 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7001 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7002 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7003 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007004 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7005 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007006 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7007 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7008 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007009 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7010 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7011 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007012
7013 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7014 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7015
7016 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7017
7018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007019option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007020option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007021no option redispatch
7022 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7023 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7024 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007025 Arguments :
7026 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7027 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7028 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007029 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007030 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007031 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007032 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7033 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7034 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007036
7037 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7038 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7039 be able to access the service anymore.
7040
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007041 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7042 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007043
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007044 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007045 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7046 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007048 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7049 "redisp" keywords.
7050
7051 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7052 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7053
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007054 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007055
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007056
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007057option redis-check
7058 Use redis health checks for server testing
7059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7060 yes | no | yes | yes
7061 Arguments : none
7062
7063 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7064 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7065 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7066 find the "+PONG" response message.
7067
7068 Example :
7069 option redis-check
7070
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007071 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007072
7073
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007074option smtpchk
7075option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7076 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7078 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007079 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007080 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007081 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007082 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7083
7084 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7085 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7086 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7087
7088 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7089 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7090 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7091 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7092 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7093 dead server.
7094
7095 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7096 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007097 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007098 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7099
7100 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7101 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7102 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7103 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007104 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007105
7106 Example :
7107 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7108
7109 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007112option socket-stats
7113no option socket-stats
7114
7115 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7117 yes | yes | yes | no
7118
7119 Arguments : none
7120
7121
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007122option splice-auto
7123no option splice-auto
7124 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7126 yes | yes | yes | yes
7127 Arguments : none
7128
7129 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7130 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007131 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007132 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007133 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007134 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7135 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7136 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7137 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7138
7139 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7140 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7141 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7142 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7143 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7144 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7145 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7146 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7147 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7148 keyword.
7149
7150 Example :
7151 option splice-auto
7152
7153 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7154 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7155
7156 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7157 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7158
7159
7160option splice-request
7161no option splice-request
7162 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7164 yes | yes | yes | yes
7165 Arguments : none
7166
7167 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007168 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007169 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7170 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7171 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7172 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7173
7174 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7175
7176 Example :
7177 option splice-request
7178
7179 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7180 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7181
7182 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7183 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7184
7185
7186option splice-response
7187no option splice-response
7188 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7190 yes | yes | yes | yes
7191 Arguments : none
7192
7193 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007194 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007195 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7196 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7197 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7198 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7199
7200 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7201
7202 Example :
7203 option splice-response
7204
7205 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7206 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7207
7208 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7209 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7210
7211
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007212option spop-check
7213 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7215 no | no | no | yes
7216 Arguments : none
7217
7218 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7219 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7220 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7221 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7222
7223 Example :
7224 option spop-check
7225
7226 See also : "option httpchk"
7227
7228
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007229option srvtcpka
7230no option srvtcpka
7231 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7233 yes | no | yes | yes
7234 Arguments : none
7235
7236 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7237 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007238 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007239 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7240
7241 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7242 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7243 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7244 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7245
7246 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7247 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7248 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7249 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7250 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7251
7252 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7253
7254 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7255 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7256 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7257
7258 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7259 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7260
7261 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7262
7263
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007264option ssl-hello-chk
7265 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7267 yes | no | yes | yes
7268 Arguments : none
7269
7270 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7271 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7272 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7273 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7274 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7275 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7276 hello message.
7277
7278 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7279 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7280 messages, which is appreciable.
7281
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007282 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7283 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7284 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007285
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007286 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7287
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007288
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007289option tcp-check
7290 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7291 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7292 yes | no | yes | yes
7293
7294 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7295 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7296
7297 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7298 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7299 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7300
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007301 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007302 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7303 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7304 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7305 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7306 only.
7307
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007308 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007309 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7310 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7311 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7312 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7313
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007314 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007315 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7316 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007317 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007318 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7319 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7320 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7321 the respective protocols.
7322 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007323 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007324
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007325 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7326 script.
7327
7328 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7329 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7330 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7331 The "comment" is of course optional.
7332
7333
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007334 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007335 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007336 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007337 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007339 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007340 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007341 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007342
7343 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7344 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007345 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007346 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007347 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007348 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007349 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007350 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007351 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7352 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007353 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007354 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7355 tcp-check expect string +OK
7356
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007357 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007358 (send many headers before analyzing)
7359 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007360 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007361 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7362 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7363 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7364 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007365 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007366
7367
7368 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7369
7370
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007371option tcp-smart-accept
7372no option tcp-smart-accept
7373 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7375 yes | yes | yes | no
7376 Arguments : none
7377
7378 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7379 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7380 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7381 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7382 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7383 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7384
7385 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7386 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7387 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7388 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7389
7390 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7391 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7392 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007393 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007394
7395 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7396 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7397 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7398
7399 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7400 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7401 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7402
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007403 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7404
7405
7406option tcp-smart-connect
7407no option tcp-smart-connect
7408 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7410 yes | no | yes | yes
7411 Arguments : none
7412
7413 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7414 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7415 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7416 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7417 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7418
7419 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7420 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7421 complex.
7422
7423 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7424 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7425 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7426
7427 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7428 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7429
7430 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7431
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007432
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007433option tcpka
7434 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7436 yes | yes | yes | yes
7437 Arguments : none
7438
7439 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7440 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007441 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007442 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7443
7444 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7445 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7446 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7447 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7448
7449 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7450 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7451 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7452 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7453 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7454
7455 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7456
7457 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7458 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7459 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7460 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7461 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7462 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7463 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7464 backends.
7465
7466 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7467
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007468
7469option tcplog
7470 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007472 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007473 Arguments : none
7474
7475 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7476 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7477 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7478 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7479 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7480 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7481 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7482 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7483
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007484 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007486 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007487
7488
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007489option transparent
7490no option transparent
7491 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007493 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007494 Arguments : none
7495
7496 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7497 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7498 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7499 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7500 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7501 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7502 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7503 appropriate server.
7504
7505 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7506 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7507
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007508 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007509 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007510
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007511
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007512external-check command <command>
7513 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7515 yes | no | yes | yes
7516
7517 Arguments :
7518 <command> is the external command to run
7519
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007520 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7521
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007522 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007523
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007524 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7525 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7526 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7527 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7528 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7529 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007530
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007531 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7532
7533 Environment variables :
7534 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7535 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7536
7537 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7538
7539 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7540
7541 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7542 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7543 for a UNIX socket).
7544
7545 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7546
7547 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7548
7549 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7550
7551 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7552
7553 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7554
7555 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7556 socket).
7557
7558 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7559 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7560
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007561 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7562 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7563 failed.
7564
7565 Example :
7566 external-check command /bin/true
7567
7568 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7569
7570
7571external-check path <path>
7572 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7574 yes | no | yes | yes
7575
7576 Arguments :
7577 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7578
7579 The default path is "".
7580
7581 Example :
7582 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7583
7584 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7585 "external-check command"
7586
7587
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007588persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007589persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007590 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7592 yes | no | yes | yes
7593 Arguments :
7594 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007595 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7596 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007597
7598 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7599 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007600 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007601 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7602 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7603 forwarded to this server.
7604
7605 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7606 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7607 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007608 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007609 a single "listen" section.
7610
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007611 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7612 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7613 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7614
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007615 Example :
7616 listen tse-farm
7617 bind :3389
7618 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7619 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7620 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7621 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7622 persist rdp-cookie
7623 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007624 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007625 balance rdp-cookie
7626 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7627 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7628
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007629 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7630 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007631
7632
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007633rate-limit sessions <rate>
7634 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7636 yes | yes | yes | no
7637 Arguments :
7638 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7639 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7640
7641 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7642 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7643 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7644 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7645 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7646 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7647
7648 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7649 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7650 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7651 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7652
7653 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7654 listen smtp
7655 mode tcp
7656 bind :25
7657 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007658 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007659
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007660 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7661 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7662 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007663
7664 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7665
7666
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007667redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7668redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7669redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007670 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7672 no | yes | yes | yes
7673
7674 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007675 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007676
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007677 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007678 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007679 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7680 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7681 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007682
7683 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7684 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7685 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7686 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7687 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007688 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7689 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7690 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7691 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007692
7693 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7694 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7695 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7696 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7697 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7698 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007699 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007700 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007701 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7702 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7703 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007704
7705 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007706 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7707 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7708 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007709 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007710 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7711 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7712 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7713 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007714
7715 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007716 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007717
7718 - "drop-query"
7719 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7720 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7721 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7722 with a location-type redirect.
7723
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007724 - "append-slash"
7725 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7726 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7727 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7728 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7729
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007730 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7731 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7732 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7733 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7734 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7735 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7736 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7737
7738 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7739 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7740 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7741 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7742 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7743 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7744 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007745
7746 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7747 acl clear dst_port 80
7748 acl secure dst_port 8080
7749 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007750 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007751 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007752 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7753
7754 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007755 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7756 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7757 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007758 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007759
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007760 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7761 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7762 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7763
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007764 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007765 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007766
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007767 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007768 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7769 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7770 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007772 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007773
7774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007775redisp (deprecated)
7776redispatch (deprecated)
7777 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7779 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007780 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007781
7782 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7783 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7784 be able to access the service anymore.
7785
7786 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7787 redistribute them to a working server.
7788
7789 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7790 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7791 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007792
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007793 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7794 "option redispatch" instead.
7795
7796 See also : "option redispatch"
7797
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007798
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007799reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007800 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7802 no | yes | yes | yes
7803 Arguments :
7804 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7805 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007806 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007807
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007808 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7809 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7810
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007811 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7812 the last header of an HTTP request.
7813
7814 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7815 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7816 responses.
7817
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007818 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7819 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7820 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7821
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007822 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7823 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007824
7825
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007826reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7827reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007828 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7830 no | yes | yes | yes
7831 Arguments :
7832 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7833 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7834 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7835 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7836 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7837 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7838 ignores case.
7839
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007840 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7841 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7842
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007843 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7844 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7845 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7846 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007847 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007848
7849 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7850 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7851
7852 Example :
7853 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7854 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7855 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7856
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007857 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7858 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007859
7860
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007861reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7862reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007863 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7865 no | yes | yes | yes
7866 Arguments :
7867 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7868 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7869 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7870 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7871 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7872 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7873
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007874 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7875 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7876
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007877 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7878 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7879 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7880 next servers.
7881
7882 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7883 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7884 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7885
7886 Example :
7887 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7888 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7889 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7890
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007891 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7892 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007893
7894
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007895reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7896reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007897 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7899 no | yes | yes | yes
7900 Arguments :
7901 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7902 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7903 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7904 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7905 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7906 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7907 case.
7908
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007909 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7910 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7911
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007912 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7913 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7914 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7915 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007916 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007917
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007918 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007919 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007920 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007921
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007922 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7923 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7924
7925 Example :
7926 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7927 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7928 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7929
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007930 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7931 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007932
7933
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007934reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7935reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007936 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7938 no | yes | yes | yes
7939 Arguments :
7940 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7941 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7942 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7943 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7944 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7945 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7946 case.
7947
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007948 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7949 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7950
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007951 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7952 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7953 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7954 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7955
7956 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7957 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7958
7959 Example :
7960 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7961 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7962 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7963 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7964
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007965 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7966 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007967
7968
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007969reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7970reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007971 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7973 no | yes | yes | yes
7974 Arguments :
7975 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7976 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7977 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7978 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7979 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7980 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7981
7982 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7983 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7984 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7985 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007986 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007987
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007988 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7989 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7990
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007991 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7992 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7993 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7994
7995 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7996 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7997 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7998 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7999 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8000
8001 Example :
8002 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008003 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008004 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8005 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8006
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008007 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8008 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008009
8010
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008011reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8012reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008013 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8015 no | yes | yes | yes
8016 Arguments :
8017 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8018 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8019 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8020 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8021 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8022 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8023 ignores case.
8024
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008025 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8026 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8027
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008028 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8029 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008030 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8031 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8032 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008033 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8034 not set.
8035
8036 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8037 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8038 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8039 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8040 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8041
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008042 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008043 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008044 # block all others.
8045 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8046 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8047
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008048 # block bad guys
8049 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8050 reqitarpit . if badguys
8051
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008052 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8053 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008054
8055
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008056retries <value>
8057 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8058 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8059 yes | no | yes | yes
8060 Arguments :
8061 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8062 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8063 default value is 3.
8064
8065 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8066 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8067 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8068
8069 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008070 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8071 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008072
8073 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8074 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8075
8076 See also : "option redispatch"
8077
8078
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008079retry-on [list of keywords]
8080 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8081 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8082 yes | no | yes | yes
8083 Arguments :
8084 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8085 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8086 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8087 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8088
8089 none never retry
8090
8091 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8092 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8093
8094 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8095 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8096 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8097 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8098 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8099 processing the request.
8100
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008101 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8102 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8103 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8104 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8105 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8106 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8107 overflow attack for example).
8108
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008109 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8110 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8111 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8112 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8113 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8114 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8115 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8116 amplify denial of service attacks.
8117
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008118 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8119 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8120 considered to be safe to retry.
8121
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008122 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8123 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8124 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8125 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8126
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008127 all-retryable-errors
8128 retry request for any error that are considered
8129 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8130 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8131 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8132
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008133 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8134 not cumulative.
8135
8136 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8137 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8138 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8139 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8140
8141 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8142 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8143 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8144 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8145 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8146 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8147 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8148 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8149 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8150 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8151 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8152 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8153
8154 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8155 should not use this directive.
8156
8157 The default is "conn-failure".
8158
8159 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8160
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008161rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008162 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8164 no | yes | yes | yes
8165 Arguments :
8166 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8167 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008168 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008169
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008170 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8171 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8172
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008173 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8174 the last header of an HTTP response.
8175
8176 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8177 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8178 responses.
8179
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008180 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8181 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008182
8183
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008184rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8185rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008186 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8188 no | yes | yes | yes
8189 Arguments :
8190 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8191 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8192 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8193 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8194 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8195 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8196 ignores case.
8197
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008198 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8199 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8200
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008201 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8202 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008203 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008204 client.
8205
8206 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8207 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8208 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8209
8210 Example :
8211 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008212 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008213
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008214 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8215 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008216
8217
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008218rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8219rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008220 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8222 no | yes | yes | yes
8223 Arguments :
8224 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8225 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8226 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8227 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8228 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8229 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8230 ignores case.
8231
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008232 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8233 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8234
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008235 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8236 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8237 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8238 case-sensitive.
8239
8240 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008241 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8242 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8243 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008244
8245 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8246 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8247
8248 Example :
8249 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8250 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8251
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008252 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8253 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008254
8255
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008256rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8257rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008258 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8260 no | yes | yes | yes
8261 Arguments :
8262 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8263 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8264 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8265 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8266 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8267 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8268 ignores case.
8269
8270 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8271 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8272 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8273 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008274 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008275
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008276 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8277 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8278
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008279 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8280 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8281 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8282
8283 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8284 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8285 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8286 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8287 are not case-sensitive.
8288
8289 Example :
8290 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8291 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8292
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008293 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8294 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008295
8296
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008297server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008298 Declare a server in a backend
8299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8300 no | no | yes | yes
8301 Arguments :
8302 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008303 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008304 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008305
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008306 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8307 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8308 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8309 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008310 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8311 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8312 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8313 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8314 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008315 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8316 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8317 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8318 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8319 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8320 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8321 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008322 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008323 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8324 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8325 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8326 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8327 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8328 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008329 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8330 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008331 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8332 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008333
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008334 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008335 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8336 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8337 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8338 adding this value to the client's port.
8339
8340 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8341 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008342 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008343
8344 Examples :
8345 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8346 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008347 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008348 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8349 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8350 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008351
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008352 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8353 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8354 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8355 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8356 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8357
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008358 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8359 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008360
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008361server-state-file-name [<file>]
8362 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8363 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8364 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8365 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8366 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8367 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8368
8369 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8370 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8371
8372 global
8373 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8374
8375 backend bk
8376 load-server-state-from-file
8377
8378 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8379 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008380
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008381server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8382 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8383 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8385 no | no | yes | yes
8386
8387 Arguments:
8388 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8389
8390 <num | range>
8391 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8392 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8393 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8394 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8395
8396 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8397
8398 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8399
8400 <params*>
8401 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8402 keyword.
8403
8404 Examples:
8405 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8406 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8407 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8408
8409 # or
8410 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8411
8412 # would be equivalent to:
8413 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8414 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8415 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8416
8417
8418
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008419source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008420source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008421source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008422 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8424 yes | no | yes | yes
8425 Arguments :
8426 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8427 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008428
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008429 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008430 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8431 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8432 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8433 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8434 supported prefixes are :
8435 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8436 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8437 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008438 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008439 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8440 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008441
8442 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8443 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008444 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8445 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8446 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008447
8448 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8449 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8450 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8451 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8452 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8453 <addr>.
8454
8455 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8456 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8457 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8458 port.
8459
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008460 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8461 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8462 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8463 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008464 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008465 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8466 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8467 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8468 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8469 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8470 HTTP header.
8471
8472 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8473 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008474 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008475 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8476 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8477 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8478 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8479 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8480 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8481 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8482
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008483 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8484 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8485 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8486 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8487 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8488 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8489
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008490 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8491 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8492 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8493 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8494
8495 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8496 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8497 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8498 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8499 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8500 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8501
8502 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8503 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8504 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8505 there are two methods :
8506
8507 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8508 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8509 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8510 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8511 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8512 of the client ranges may be used.
8513
8514 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8515 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8516 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8517 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8518 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8519 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8520 same session.
8521
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008522 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8523 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8524 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008525 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008526
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008527 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8528
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008529 Examples :
8530 backend private
8531 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8532 source 192.168.1.200
8533
8534 backend transparent_ssl1
8535 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8536 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8537
8538 backend transparent_ssl2
8539 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8540 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8541 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8542
8543 backend transparent_ssl3
8544 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8545 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8546 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8547
8548 backend transparent_smtp
8549 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8550 # with Tproxy version 4.
8551 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8552
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008553 backend transparent_http
8554 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8555 # proxy.
8556 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008558 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008559 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8560
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008561
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008562srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8563 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8565 yes | no | yes | yes
8566 Arguments :
8567 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8568 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8569 as explained at the top of this document.
8570
8571 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8572 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8573 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8574 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8575 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8576 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8577 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8578
8579 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8580 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8581 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8582 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8583 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008584 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008585 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008586 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008587
8588 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8589 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8590 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8591 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8592 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8593 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8594
8595 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8596 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8597
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008598 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8599 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008600
8601
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008602stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8603 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008605 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008606
8607 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8608 matched.
8609
8610 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8611 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8612
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008613 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8614 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008615 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008616
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008617 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8618 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8619 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8620 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008621
8622 Example :
8623 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8624 backend stats_localhost
8625 stats enable
8626 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8627
8628 Example :
8629 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8630 backend stats_auth
8631 stats enable
8632 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8633 stats admin if TRUE
8634
8635 Example :
8636 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8637 userlist stats-auth
8638 group admin users admin
8639 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8640 group readonly users haproxy
8641 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8642
8643 backend stats_auth
8644 stats enable
8645 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8646 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8647 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8648 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8649
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008650 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8651 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8652 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008653
8654
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008655stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8656 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008658 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008659 Arguments :
8660 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8661
8662 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8663
8664 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8665 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8666 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8667 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8668 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8669 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8670
8671 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8672 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8673 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008674 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008675
8676 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8677 report using "stats scope".
8678
8679 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8680 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8681 unobvious parameters.
8682
8683 Example :
8684 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8685 backend public_www
8686 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8687 stats enable
8688 stats hide-version
8689 stats scope .
8690 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008691 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008692 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8693 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8694
8695 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8696 backend private_monitoring
8697 stats enable
8698 stats uri /admin?stats
8699 stats refresh 5s
8700
8701 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8702
8703
8704stats enable
8705 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008707 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008708 Arguments : none
8709
8710 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8711 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8712 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8713 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8714 - stats auth : no authentication
8715 - stats scope : no restriction
8716
8717 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8718 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8719 unobvious parameters.
8720
8721 Example :
8722 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8723 backend public_www
8724 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8725 stats enable
8726 stats hide-version
8727 stats scope .
8728 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008729 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008730 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8731 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8732
8733 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8734 backend private_monitoring
8735 stats enable
8736 stats uri /admin?stats
8737 stats refresh 5s
8738
8739 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8740
8741
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008742stats hide-version
8743 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008745 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008746 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008747
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008748 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8749 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8750 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8751 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8752 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8753 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008755 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8756 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8757 unobvious parameters.
8758
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008759 Example :
8760 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8761 backend public_www
8762 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008763 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008764 stats hide-version
8765 stats scope .
8766 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008767 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008768 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8769 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008770
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008771 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8772 backend private_monitoring
8773 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008774 stats uri /admin?stats
8775 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008776
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008777 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008778
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008779
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008780stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8781 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8782 Access control for statistics
8783
8784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8785 no | no | yes | yes
8786
8787 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8788 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8789 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8790 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8791 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8792 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8793
8794 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8795 instance.
8796
8797 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8798 about ACL usage.
8799
8800
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008801stats realm <realm>
8802 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008804 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008805 Arguments :
8806 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8807 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8808 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8809
8810 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8811 using a backslash ('\').
8812
8813 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8814 only related to authentication.
8815
8816 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8817 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8818 unobvious parameters.
8819
8820 Example :
8821 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8822 backend public_www
8823 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8824 stats enable
8825 stats hide-version
8826 stats scope .
8827 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008828 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008829 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8830 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8831
8832 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8833 backend private_monitoring
8834 stats enable
8835 stats uri /admin?stats
8836 stats refresh 5s
8837
8838 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8839
8840
8841stats refresh <delay>
8842 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008844 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008845 Arguments :
8846 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8847 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8848 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8849 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8850 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8851 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8852
8853 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8854 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8855 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8856 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8857
8858 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8859 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8860 unobvious parameters.
8861
8862 Example :
8863 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8864 backend public_www
8865 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8866 stats enable
8867 stats hide-version
8868 stats scope .
8869 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008870 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008871 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8872 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8873
8874 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8875 backend private_monitoring
8876 stats enable
8877 stats uri /admin?stats
8878 stats refresh 5s
8879
8880 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8881
8882
8883stats scope { <name> | "." }
8884 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008886 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008887 Arguments :
8888 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8889 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8890 section in which the statement appears.
8891
8892 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8893 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8894 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8895 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8896 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8897 exists.
8898
8899 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8900 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8901 unobvious parameters.
8902
8903 Example :
8904 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8905 backend public_www
8906 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8907 stats enable
8908 stats hide-version
8909 stats scope .
8910 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008911 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008912 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8913 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8914
8915 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8916 backend private_monitoring
8917 stats enable
8918 stats uri /admin?stats
8919 stats refresh 5s
8920
8921 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8922
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008923
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008924stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008925 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008927 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008928
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008929 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008930 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8931
8932 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8933 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8934
8935 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8936 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008937 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008938
8939 Example :
8940 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8941 backend private_monitoring
8942 stats enable
8943 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8944 stats uri /admin?stats
8945 stats refresh 5s
8946
8947 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8948 global section.
8949
8950
8951stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008952 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8954 yes | yes | yes | yes
8955 Arguments : none
8956
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008957 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008958 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8959 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8960 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8961 - IP (socket, server)
8962 - cookie (backend, server)
8963
8964 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8965 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008966 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008967
8968 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8969
8970
8971stats show-node [ <name> ]
8972 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008974 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008975 Arguments:
8976 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8977 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8978
8979 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8980 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008981 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008982
8983 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8984 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8985 unobvious parameters.
8986
8987 Example:
8988 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8989 backend private_monitoring
8990 stats enable
8991 stats show-node Europe-1
8992 stats uri /admin?stats
8993 stats refresh 5s
8994
8995 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8996 section.
8997
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008998
8999stats uri <prefix>
9000 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009002 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009003 Arguments :
9004 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9005 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9006 query string.
9007
9008 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9009 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9010 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9011 possible to reach it in the application.
9012
9013 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009014 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009015 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9016 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9017 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9018 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9019
9020 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9021 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9022 an address or a port to statistics only.
9023
9024 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9025 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9026 unobvious parameters.
9027
9028 Example :
9029 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9030 backend public_www
9031 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9032 stats enable
9033 stats hide-version
9034 stats scope .
9035 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009036 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009037 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9038 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9039
9040 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9041 backend private_monitoring
9042 stats enable
9043 stats uri /admin?stats
9044 stats refresh 5s
9045
9046 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9047
9048
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009049stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9050 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009052 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009053
9054 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009055 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009056 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009057 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009058 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9059
9060 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9061 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9062 the "stick-table" statement.
9063
9064 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9065 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9066 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9067 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9068 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9069
9070 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9071 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9072 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9073 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9074 transformation rules.
9075
9076 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9077 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9078 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9079 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9080 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9081 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9082 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9083
9084 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9085 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9086 ACL based conditions.
9087
9088 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9089 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9090 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9091 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9092
9093 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9094 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9095 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9096 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9097
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009098 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9099 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009100 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009101
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009102 Example :
9103 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9104 # last 30 minutes
9105 backend pop
9106 mode tcp
9107 balance roundrobin
9108 stick store-request src
9109 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9110 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9111 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9112
9113 backend smtp
9114 mode tcp
9115 balance roundrobin
9116 stick match src table pop
9117 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9118 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9119
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009120 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009121 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009122
9123
9124stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9125 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9127 no | no | yes | yes
9128
9129 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9130 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9131 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9132 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9133
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009134 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9135 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009136 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009137
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009138 Examples :
9139 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009140 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009141
9142 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9143 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9144 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9145
9146
9147 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9148 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9149 backend http
9150 mode http
9151 balance roundrobin
9152 stick on src table https
9153 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9154 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9155 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9156
9157 backend https
9158 mode tcp
9159 balance roundrobin
9160 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9161 stick on src
9162 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9163 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9164
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009165 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009166
9167
9168stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9169 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9171 no | no | yes | yes
9172
9173 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009174 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009175 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009176 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009177 server is selected.
9178
9179 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9180 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9181 the "stick-table" statement.
9182
9183 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9184 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9185 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9186 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9187 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9188 address.
9189
9190 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9191 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9192 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9193 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9194 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9195 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9196 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9197 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9198 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9199 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9200
9201 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9202 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9203 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9204 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9205 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9206 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9207 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9208
9209 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9210 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9211 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9212 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9213
9214 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9215 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9216 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9217 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9218 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9219 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009220 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9221 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9222 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9223 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9224 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9225 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009226
9227 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9228 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9229 the request.
9230
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009231 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9232 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009233 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009234
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009235 Example :
9236 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9237 # last 30 minutes
9238 backend pop
9239 mode tcp
9240 balance roundrobin
9241 stick store-request src
9242 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9243 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9244 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9245
9246 backend smtp
9247 mode tcp
9248 balance roundrobin
9249 stick match src table pop
9250 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9251 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9252
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009253 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009254 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009255
9256
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009257stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009258 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9259 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009260 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009262 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009263
9264 Arguments :
9265 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9266 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9267 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9268 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9269
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009270 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9271 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9272 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9273 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9274
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009275 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9276 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9277 instance.
9278
9279 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9280 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9281 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9282 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9283 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9284 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009285 to 32 characters.
9286
9287 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9288 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9289 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009290 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009291 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9292 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009293
9294 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009295 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9296 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009297 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9298 increase.
9299
9300 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009301 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9302 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9303 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009304
9305 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9306 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9307 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9308 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009309 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009310 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9311 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9312 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9313 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9314 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9315 parameter (see below).
9316
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009317 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9318 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9319 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9320 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9321 soft restart.
9322
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009323 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9324 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009325
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009326 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9327 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9328 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9329 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009330 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009331 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009332 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9333 if not expiration delay is specified.
9334
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009335 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9336 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9337 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9338 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009339 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9340 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9341 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9342 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9343 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9344 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9345 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9346 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9347 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9348 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9349 types and their arguments.
9350
9351 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9352 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9353 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9354 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9355
9356 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9357 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9358 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009359 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009360
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009361 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9362 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9363 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009364 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009365 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009366 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009367
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009368 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9369 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9370 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9371 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9372
9373 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9374 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9375 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9376 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9377 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9378 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9379
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009380 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9381 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9382 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9383 they were received.
9384
9385 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9386 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9387 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9388 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9389 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9390
9391 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9392 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9393 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9394 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9395 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9396
9397 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9398 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9399 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9400
9401 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9402 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9403 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9404 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9405 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9406
9407 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9408 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9409 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9410 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9411 the client side.
9412
9413 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9414 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9415 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9416 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9417 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9418 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9419 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9420
9421 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9422 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9423 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9424 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9425 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9426 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009427 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009428
9429 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9430 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9431 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9432 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9433 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9434 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9435
9436 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009437 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009438 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9439 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9440
9441 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9442 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9443 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9444 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9445 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9446 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9447 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9448 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9449 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9450 recommended for better fairness.
9451
9452 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009453 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009454 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9455 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9456
9457 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9458 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9459 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9460 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9461 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9462 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9463 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9464 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9465 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9466 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009467
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009468 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9469 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009470 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9471 reference it.
9472
9473 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9474 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009475 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9476 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9477 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009478
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009479 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9480 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9481 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9482 something that can be ignored.
9483
9484 Example:
9485 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9486 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9487 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9488 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9489
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009490 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009491 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009492
9493
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009494stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009495 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9497 no | no | yes | yes
9498
9499 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009500 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009501 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009502 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009503 server is selected.
9504
9505 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9506 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9507 the "stick-table" statement.
9508
9509 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9510 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9511 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9512 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9513
9514 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9515 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9516 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9517 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9518 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9519 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009520 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009521 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9522 rules.
9523
9524 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9525 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9526 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9527 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9528 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9529 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9530 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9531
9532 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9533 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9534 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9535 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9536
9537 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9538 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9539 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9540 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9541 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9542 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009543 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9544 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9545 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9546 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9547 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9548 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9549 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9550 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9551 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009552
9553 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9554
9555 Example :
9556 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9557 backend https
9558 mode tcp
9559 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009560 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009561 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009562
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009563 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9564 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9565
9566 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9567 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9568 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9569
9570 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9571 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009572
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009573 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9574 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9575 # at offset 44.
9576
9577 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9578 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9579
9580 # Learn on response if server hello.
9581 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009582
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009583 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9584 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9585
9586 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9587 extraction.
9588
9589
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009590tcp-check connect [params*]
9591 Opens a new connection
9592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9593 no | no | yes | yes
9594
9595 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9596 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9597 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9598
9599 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9600 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9601 of the sequence.
9602
9603 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9604 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9605 do.
9606
9607 Parameters :
9608 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9609 use the TCP connection.
9610
9611 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9612 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9613 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9614
9615 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9616
9617 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9618
9619 Examples:
9620 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9621 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9622 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9623 option tcp-check
9624 tcp-check connect
9625 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9626 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9627 tcp-check send \r\n
9628 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9629 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9630 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9631 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9632 tcp-check send \r\n
9633 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9634 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9635
9636 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9637 option tcp-check
9638 tcp-check connect port 110
9639 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9640 tcp-check connect port 143
9641 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9642 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9643
9644 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9645
9646
9647tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009648 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009649 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9650 no | no | yes | yes
9651
9652 Arguments :
9653 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9654 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9655 binary.
9656 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9657 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9658 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9659
9660 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9661 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9662 with the usual backslash ('\').
9663 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009664 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009665 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9666 used upper or lower case.
9667
9668
9669 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9670
9671 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9672 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9673 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9674 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9675 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9676 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9677 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9678 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9679
9680 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9681 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9682 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9683 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9684 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9685 expression.
9686
9687 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9688 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9689 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9690 this exact hexadecimal string.
9691 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9692
9693 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9694 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9695 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9696 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9697 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9698 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9699 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9700 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9701 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9702 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9703 the null character.
9704
9705 Examples :
9706 # perform a POP check
9707 option tcp-check
9708 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9709
9710 # perform an IMAP check
9711 option tcp-check
9712 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9713
9714 # look for the redis master server
9715 option tcp-check
9716 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009717 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009718 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9719 tcp-check expect string role:master
9720 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9721 tcp-check expect string +OK
9722
9723
9724 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9725 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9726
9727
9728tcp-check send <data>
9729 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9730 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9731 no | no | yes | yes
9732
9733 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9734 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9735
9736 Examples :
9737 # look for the redis master server
9738 option tcp-check
9739 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9740 tcp-check expect string role:master
9741
9742 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9743 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9744
9745
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009746tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9747 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009748 tcp health check
9749 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9750 no | no | yes | yes
9751
9752 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9753 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009754 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009755 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9756 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9757 hexadecimal string.
9758 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9759
9760 Examples :
9761 # redis check in binary
9762 option tcp-check
9763 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9764 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9765
9766
9767 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9768 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9769
9770
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009771tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9772 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9774 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009775 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009776 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9777 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009778
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009779 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009780
9781 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9782 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009783 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9784 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9785 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9786 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9787 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9788 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009789
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009790 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9791 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9792 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9793 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009794
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009795 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009796 - accept :
9797 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9798 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9799 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009800
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009801 - reject :
9802 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9803 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9804 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9805 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9806 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9807 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9808 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9809 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9810 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9811 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9812 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009813 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009814
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009815 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9816 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9817 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9818 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9819 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9820 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9821 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9822 hosts.
9823
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009824 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9825 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9826 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9827 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9828 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9829 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9830 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9831 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9832
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009833 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9834 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9835 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9836 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9837 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9838 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9839 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9840 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9841 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009842 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9843 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009844
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009845 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009846 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009847 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9848 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9849 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9850 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9851 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9852 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9853 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9854 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9855 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9856 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9857 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9858 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009859
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009860 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009861 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009862 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009863 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009864 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9865 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9866 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009867
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009868 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9869 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9870 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9871 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009872
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009873 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9874 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9875 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9876 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9877 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009878 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9879 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9880 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9881 layer7 information is extracted.
9882
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009883 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9884 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9885 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9886 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9887 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009888
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009889 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9890 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9891 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9892 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9893
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009894 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9895 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9896 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9897 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9898
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009899 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9900 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9901 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9902 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9903 continues.
9904
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009905 - set-src <expr> :
9906 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9907 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9908 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009909 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009910
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009911 Arguments:
9912 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9913 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009914
9915 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009916 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9917
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009918 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9919 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009920
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009921 - set-src-port <expr> :
9922 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9923 expression.
9924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009925 Arguments:
9926 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9927 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009928
9929 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009930 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9931
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009932 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9933 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9934 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009935
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009936 - set-dst <expr> :
9937 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9938 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9939 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9940 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9941 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9942
9943 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9944 followed by some converters.
9945
9946 Example:
9947
9948 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9949 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9950
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009951 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9952 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9953
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009954 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9955 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9956 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9957 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9958
9959
9960 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9961 followed by some converters.
9962
9963 Example:
9964
9965 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9966
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009967 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9968 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9969 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9970
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009971 - "silent-drop" :
9972 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009973 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009974 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9975 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9976 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9977 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9978 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009979 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9980 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009981 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9982 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009983 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009984 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9985 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9986 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9987 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9988
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009989 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9990 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9991 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009993 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9994 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9995 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009996
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009997 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009998 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009999 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010000
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010001 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10002 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10003 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010005 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010006 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10007 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010008
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010009 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10010
10011 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10012
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010013 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10014
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010015 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010016
10017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010018tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10019 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010021 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010022 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010023 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10024 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010025
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010026 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010027
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010028 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010029 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10030 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10031 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10032 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010033
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010034 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10035 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10036 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10037 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010038 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10039 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10040 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10041 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10042 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10043 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010044 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010045 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010047 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10048 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10049 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10050 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010051
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010052 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010053 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010054 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010055 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10056 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010057 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010058 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010059 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010060 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010061 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010062 - set-dst <expr>
10063 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010064 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010065 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010066 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010067 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010068
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010069 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10070 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010071 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10072 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010073
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010074 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10075 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10076 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10077 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10078 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10079 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010081 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010082 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10083 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010084
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010085 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010086 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10087 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10088 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10089 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010090 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10091 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10092 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010093
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010094 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010095 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10096 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10097 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010098
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010099 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10100 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10101
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010102 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010103 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10104 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010105
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010106 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10107 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010108 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010109 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10110 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010111 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010112 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010113 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010114 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10115 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010116 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010117 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10118 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010119
10120 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10121 followed by some converters.
10122
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010123 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10124 <var-name>.
10125
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010126 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10127 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10128 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10129 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10130 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10131
10132 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10133 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10134 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10135 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10136 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10137 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10138 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10139 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10140 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10141 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10142 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10143
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010144 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10145 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10146 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10147 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10148 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10149
10150 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10151
10152 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10153
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010154 Example:
10155
10156 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010157 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010158
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010159 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010160 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10161 # and reject everything else.
10162 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10163 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010164 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010165 tcp-request content reject
10166
10167 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010168 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10169 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10170 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010171 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010172
10173 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10174 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10175 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010176 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010177 tcp-request content reject
10178
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010179 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010180 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010181 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010182 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010183 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10184 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010185
10186 Example:
10187 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10188 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010189 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010190
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010191 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010192 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010193
10194 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010195 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010196 # protecting all our sites
10197 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010198 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10199 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010200 ...
10201 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10202
10203 backend http_dynamic
10204 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010205 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010206 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010207 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010208 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010209 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010210 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010212 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010213
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010214 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10215 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010216
10217
10218tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10219 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010221 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010222 Arguments :
10223 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10224 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10225 as explained at the top of this document.
10226
10227 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10228 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10229 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10230 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10231 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10232
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010233 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10234 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10235 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10236 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10237
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010238 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10239 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010240 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010241 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010242 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10243 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10244 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10245 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010246
10247 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10248 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10249 it pass through unaffected.
10250
10251 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10252 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10253 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010254 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010255 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10256 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010257 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10258 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10259 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010260
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010261 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010262 "timeout client".
10263
10264
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010265tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10266 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10268 no | no | yes | yes
10269 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010270 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10271 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010272
10273 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010275 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010276 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10277 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010278 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10279 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010280
10281 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10282
10283 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10284 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10285 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10286 inserted.
10287
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010288 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010289 - accept :
10290 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10291 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10292 the rules evaluation.
10293
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010294 - close :
10295 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10296 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10297 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10298 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10299 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10300 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010301 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010302 protocols.
10303
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010304 - reject :
10305 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10306 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010307 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010308
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010309 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10310 Sets a variable.
10311
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010312 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10313 Unsets a variable.
10314
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010315 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10316 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10317 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10318 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10319
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010320 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10321 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10322 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10323 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10324
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010325 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10326 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10327 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10328 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10329 continues.
10330
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010331 - "silent-drop" :
10332 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010333 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010334 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10335 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10336 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10337 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10338 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010339 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10340 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010341 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10342 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010343 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010344 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10345 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10346 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10347 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10348
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010349 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10350 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10351
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010352 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10353 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10354 for changing the default action to a reject.
10355
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010356 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10357 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10358 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10359 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010360 period.
10361
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010362 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10363 declared inline.
10364
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010365 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10366 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010367 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010368 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10369 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010370 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010371 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010372 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010373 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10374 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010375 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010376 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10377 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010378
10379 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10380 followed by some converters.
10381
10382 Example:
10383
10384 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10385
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010386 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10387 <var-name>.
10388
10389 Example:
10390
10391 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10392
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010393 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10394 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10395 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10396 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10397 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10398
10399 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10400
10401 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10402
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010403 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10404
10405 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10406
10407
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010408tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10409 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10411 no | yes | yes | no
10412 Arguments :
10413 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10414 below.
10415
10416 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10417
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010418 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010419 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10420 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10421 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10422 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10423 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10424 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10425 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010426 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010427 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10428 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10429 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10430 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10431 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10432 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10433 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10434 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10435 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10436 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10437 instead.
10438
10439 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10440 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10441 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10442 rules which may be inserted.
10443
10444 Several types of actions are supported :
10445 - accept : the request is accepted
10446 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10447 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10448 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010449 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010450 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10451 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010452 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010453 - silent-drop
10454
10455 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10456 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10457 sections for a complete description.
10458
10459 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10460 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10461 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10462
10463 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10464 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10465 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10466 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10467 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10468
10469 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10470 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10471
10472 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10473 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10474 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10475
10476 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10477 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10478 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10479
10480 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10481 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10482 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10483
10484 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10485 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10486 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10487
10488 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10489
10490 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10491
10492
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010493tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10494 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10496 no | no | yes | yes
10497 Arguments :
10498 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10499 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10500 as explained at the top of this document.
10501
10502 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10503
10504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010505timeout check <timeout>
10506 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10507 established.
10508
10509 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10510 yes | no | yes | yes
10511 Arguments:
10512 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10513 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10514 as explained at the top of this document.
10515
10516 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10517 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010518 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010519 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010520 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10521 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10522 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010523
10524 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10525 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10526
10527 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10528 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010529 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010530
10531 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10532 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10533 forget about it.
10534
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010535 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10536 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010537
10538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010539timeout client <timeout>
10540timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10541 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10543 yes | yes | yes | no
10544 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010545 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010546 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10547 as explained at the top of this document.
10548
10549 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10550 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10551 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010552 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10553 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10554 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10555 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010556 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10557 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10558 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010559 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010560 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010561 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10562 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010563 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10564 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010565
10566 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10567 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10568 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10569 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10570 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10571 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10572
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010573 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010574
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010575 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10576 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10577 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10578
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010579 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10580 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010581
10582
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010583timeout client-fin <timeout>
10584 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10586 yes | yes | yes | no
10587 Arguments :
10588 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10589 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10590 as explained at the top of this document.
10591
10592 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10593 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10594 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10595 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10596 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10597 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10598 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010599 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10600 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10601 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010602
10603 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10604 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10605 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10606
10607 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10608
10609
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010610timeout connect <timeout>
10611timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10612 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10614 yes | no | yes | yes
10615 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010616 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010617 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10618 as explained at the top of this document.
10619
10620 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010621 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010622 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010623 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010624 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10625 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010626
10627 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10628 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10629 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10630 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10631 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10632 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10633
10634 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10635 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10636 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10637
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010638 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10639 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010640
10641
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010642timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10643 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10645 yes | yes | yes | yes
10646 Arguments :
10647 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10648 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10649 as explained at the top of this document.
10650
10651 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10652 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10653 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10654 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10655 once the request has started to present itself.
10656
10657 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10658 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10659 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10660 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10661 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10662
10663 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10664 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10665 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10666 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10667
10668 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10669 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010670 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010671 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10672 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010673 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010674
10675 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10676 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10677 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10678 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10679
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010680 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10681 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010682 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10683
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010684 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10685
10686
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010687timeout http-request <timeout>
10688 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010690 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010691 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010692 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010693 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10694 as explained at the top of this document.
10695
10696 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10697 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10698 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10699 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10700 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10701 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10702 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010703 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10704 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10705 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10706 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010707 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010708 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10709 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010710
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010711 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10712 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10713 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10714 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10715 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010716 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010717
10718 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10719 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010720 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010721 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10722 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10723
10724 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010725 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10726 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10727 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010728
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010729 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010730 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010731
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010732
10733timeout queue <timeout>
10734 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10736 yes | no | yes | yes
10737 Arguments :
10738 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10739 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10740 as explained at the top of this document.
10741
10742 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10743 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10744 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10745 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10746 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10747
10748 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10749 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10750 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10751 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10752
10753 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10754
10755
10756timeout server <timeout>
10757timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10758 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10760 yes | no | yes | yes
10761 Arguments :
10762 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10763 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10764 as explained at the top of this document.
10765
10766 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10767 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10768 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10769 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10770 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10771 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10772 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10773
10774 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10775 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10776 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10777 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10778 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010779 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010780 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010781 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10782 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010783 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10784 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010785
10786 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10787 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10788 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10789 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10790 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10791 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10792
10793 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10794 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10795 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10796
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010797 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010798
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010799
10800timeout server-fin <timeout>
10801 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10803 yes | no | yes | yes
10804 Arguments :
10805 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10806 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10807 as explained at the top of this document.
10808
10809 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10810 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10811 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10812 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10813 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10814 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10815 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10816 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10817 situations, it should not be needed.
10818
10819 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10820 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10821 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10822
10823 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10824
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010825
10826timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010827 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10829 yes | yes | yes | yes
10830 Arguments :
10831 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10833 as explained at the top of this document.
10834
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010835 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10836 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10837 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10838 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010839
10840 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10841 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10842 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10843 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010844 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010845
10846 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10847
10848
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010849timeout tunnel <timeout>
10850 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10852 yes | no | yes | yes
10853 Arguments :
10854 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10855 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10856 as explained at the top of this document.
10857
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010858 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010859 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10860 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10861 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010862 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10863 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010864 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10865 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10866 specified.
10867
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010868 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10869 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10870 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10871 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10872 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10873 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10874 state.
10875
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010876 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10877 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10878 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10879 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010880 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010881
10882 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10883 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10884 forget about it.
10885
10886 Example :
10887 defaults http
10888 option http-server-close
10889 timeout connect 5s
10890 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010891 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010892 timeout server 30s
10893 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10894
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010895 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010896
10897
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010898transparent (deprecated)
10899 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010901 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010902 Arguments : none
10903
10904 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10905 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10906 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10907 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10908 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10909 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10910 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10911 appropriate server.
10912
10913 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10914
10915 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10916 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10917
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010918 See also: "option transparent"
10919
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010920unique-id-format <string>
10921 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10923 yes | yes | yes | no
10924 Arguments :
10925 <string> is a log-format string.
10926
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010927 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10928 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10929 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10930 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010931
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010932 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10933 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10934 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10935 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10936 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10937 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10938 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10939 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010940
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010941 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10942 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010943
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010944 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010945
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010946 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010947
10948 will generate:
10949
10950 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10951
10952 See also: "unique-id-header"
10953
10954unique-id-header <name>
10955 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10957 yes | yes | yes | no
10958 Arguments :
10959 <name> is the name of the header.
10960
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010961 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10962 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010963
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010964 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010965
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010966 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010967 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10968
10969 will generate:
10970
10971 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10972
10973 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010974
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010975use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010976 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10978 no | yes | yes | no
10979 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010980 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10981 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010982
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010983 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10984 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010985
10986 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10987 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10988 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010989 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010990 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010991 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10992 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010993
10994 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10995 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10996 assign the backend.
10997
10998 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10999 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11000 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11001 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11002 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11003 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11004
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011005 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011006 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011007 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11008 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11009 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11010
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011011 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11012 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11013 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11014 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11015 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11016 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11017 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11018 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11019 cannot be forced from the request.
11020
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011021 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011022 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11023 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11024
11025 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11026 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011027
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011028
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011029use-server <server> if <condition>
11030use-server <server> unless <condition>
11031 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11033 no | no | yes | yes
11034 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011035 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011036
11037 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11038
11039 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11040 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11041 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11042
11043 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11044 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11045 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11046 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11047 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11048 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11049 matches will assign the server.
11050
11051 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11052 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11053 with the next rules until one matches.
11054
11055 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11056 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11057 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11058 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11059
11060 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11061 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11062 stripped.
11063
11064 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11065 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11066 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11067 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11068
11069 Example :
11070 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11071 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11072 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11073 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11074 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11075 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011076 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011077 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11078 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11079
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011080 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011081
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011082
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100110835. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011084--------------------------
11085
11086The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11087depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11088settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11089written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11090described in this section.
11091
11092
110935.1. Bind options
11094-----------------
11095
11096The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11097as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11098no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11099parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11100while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11101provided immediately after the setting name.
11102
11103The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11104
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011105accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11106 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11107 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11108 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11109 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11110 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11111 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11112 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11113 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11114 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011115 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11116 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11117 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011118
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011119accept-proxy
11120 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011121 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11122 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011123 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11124 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11125 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11126 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011127 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011128 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11129 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011130 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11131 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011132
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011133allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011134 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011135 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
11136 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
11137 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11138 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011139
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011140alpn <protocols>
11141 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11142 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11143 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11144 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11145 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011146 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11147 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11148 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11149 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11150 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11151 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11152 preference, like below :
11153
11154 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011155
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011156backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011157 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011158 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11159
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011160curves <curves>
11161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11162 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11163 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11164 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11165 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11166 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11167
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011168ecdhe <named curve>
11169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011170 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11171 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011172
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011173ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011174 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11175 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11176 client's certificate.
11177
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011178ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11180 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11181 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11182 error is ignored.
11183
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011184ca-sign-file <cafile>
11185 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11186 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11187 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11188 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11189 'generate-certificates' for details.
11190
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011191ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11193 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11194 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11195 'generate-certificates' for details.
11196
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011197ciphers <ciphers>
11198 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11199 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011200 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011201 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011202 information and recommendations see e.g.
11203 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11204 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11205 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11206
11207ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11209 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11210 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11211 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011212 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11213 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011214
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011215crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011216 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11217 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11218 to verify client's certificate.
11219
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011220crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11222 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11223 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11224 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11225 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11226 file.
11227
11228 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11229 are loaded.
11230
11231 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011232 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011233 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11234 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11235 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11236 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011237 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11238 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011239 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011240
11241 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11242 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11243 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11244 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011245 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11246 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011247
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011248 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011249
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011250 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011251 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011252 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11253 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011254 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11255 clients).
11256
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011257 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11258 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11259 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11260 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11261 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11262 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11263 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11264 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11265 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11266 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11267 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11268 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11269 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11270
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011271 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11272 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11273 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11274 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11275 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11276
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011277 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11278 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11279 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11280 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011281
11282 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11283 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11284 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11285 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11286 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11287 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11288 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11289 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11290 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11291
11292 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11293
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011294 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011295 a cert bundle.
11296
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011297 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011298 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11299 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11300 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11301 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11302 provide multi-cert support.
11303
11304 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11305
11306 Filename | CN | SAN
11307 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11308 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011309 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011310 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11311 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11312
11313 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11314 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11315 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11316 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011317 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11318 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11319 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011320
11321 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11322 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11323
11324 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11325 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11326 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11327
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011328crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011329 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011330 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011331 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011332 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011333
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011334crt-list <file>
11335 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011336 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11337 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011338
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011339 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11340
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011341 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11342 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011343 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011344 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011345
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011346 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11347 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11348 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11349 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11350 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11351 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11352 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11353 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011354
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011355 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011356 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011357 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11358 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11359 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011360
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011361 crt-list file example:
11362 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011363 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011364 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011365 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011366
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011367defer-accept
11368 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11369 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11370 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011371 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011372 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11373 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11374 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11375 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11376 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11377 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11378 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11379
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011380expose-fd listeners
11381 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11382 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011383 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11384 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011385 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011386
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011387force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011388 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011389 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011390 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011391 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011392
11393force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011394 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011395 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011396 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011397
11398force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011399 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011400 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011401 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011402
11403force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011404 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011405 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011406 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011407
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011408force-tlsv13
11409 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11410 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011411 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011412
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011413generate-certificates
11414 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11415 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11416 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11417 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11418 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11419 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11420 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11421 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11422 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11423 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11424 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11425
11426 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11427 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011428 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011429 certificate is used many times.
11430
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011431gid <gid>
11432 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11433 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11434 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11435 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11436 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11437
11438group <group>
11439 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11440 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11441 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11442 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11443 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11444
11445id <id>
11446 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11447 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11448 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11449 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11450
11451interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011452 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11453 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11454 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11455 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11456 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11457 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011458 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11459 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11460 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11461 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11462 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11463 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011464
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011465level <level>
11466 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11467 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11468 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011469 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011470 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11471 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11472 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011473 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011474 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011475 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011476 all counters).
11477
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011478severity-output <format>
11479 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11480 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11481 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11482 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11483 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11484 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11485 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11486 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11487 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11488 rfc5424 convention.
11489
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011490maxconn <maxconn>
11491 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11492 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11493 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11494 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11495 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11496 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11497 eat all memory.
11498
11499mode <mode>
11500 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11501 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11502 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11503 UNIX sockets.
11504
11505mss <maxseg>
11506 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11507 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11508 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11509 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11510 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11511 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11512 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11513 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11514 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11515 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11516 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11517
11518name <name>
11519 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11520 page.
11521
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011522namespace <name>
11523 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11524 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11525 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11526 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11527
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011528nice <nice>
11529 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11530 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11531 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11532 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11533 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11534 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11535 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11536 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11537 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11538 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11539 one for an RDP socket.
11540
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011541no-ca-names
11542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11543 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11544
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011545no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011546 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011547 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011548 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011549 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011550 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11551 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011552
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011553no-tls-tickets
11554 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11555 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11556 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011557 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11558 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011559
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011560no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011561 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011562 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011563 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011564 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011565 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11566 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011567
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011568no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011569 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011570 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011571 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011572 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011573 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11574 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011575
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011576no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011577 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011578 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011579 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011580 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011581 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11582 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011583
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011584no-tlsv13
11585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11586 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11587 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11588 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011589 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11590 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011591
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011592npn <protocols>
11593 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11594 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11595 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11596 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011597 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011598 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11599 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11600 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11601 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11602 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011603
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011604prefer-client-ciphers
11605 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11606 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11607 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011608 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11609 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11610 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011611
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011612process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011613 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011614 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011615 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011616 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11617 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11618 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11619 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011620 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011621 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11622 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11623 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11624 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11625 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011626
11627 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11628
11629 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11630 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11631 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11632 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11633 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11634 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11635 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11636 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011637
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011638proto <name>
11639 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11640 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11641 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11642 in haproxy -vv.
11643 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11644 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011645 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011646 h2" on the bind line.
11647
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011648ssl
11649 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011650 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011651 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11652 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011653 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11654 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011655
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011656ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11657 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11658 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11659 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11660
11661ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11662 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11663 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11664 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11665
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011666strict-sni
11667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11668 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11669 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11670 See the "crt" option for more information.
11671
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011672tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011673 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011674 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11675 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011676 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011677 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11678 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11679 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11680 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11681 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11682 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11683 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11684
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011685tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011686 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011687 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11688 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11689 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11690 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11691 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11692 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11693 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011694 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11695 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11696 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011697
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011698tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11699 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011700 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11701 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11702 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11703 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11704 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11705 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11706 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11707 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11708 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11709 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011710 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11711 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11712
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011713transparent
11714 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11715 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11716 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11717 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11718 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11719 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11720 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11721 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11722 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11723 so check for support with your vendor.
11724
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011725v4v6
11726 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11727 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11728 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11729 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011730 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011731
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011732v6only
11733 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11734 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11735 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011736 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11737 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011738
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011739uid <uid>
11740 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11741 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11742 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11743 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11744 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11745
11746user <user>
11747 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11748 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11749 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11750 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11751 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11752
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011753verify [none|optional|required]
11754 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11755 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11756 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11757 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11758 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011759 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11760 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11761 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11762 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011763
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200117645.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011765------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011767The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11768which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11769arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11770settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11771after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11772Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11773address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011775 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011776 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011777
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011778Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11779keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011781The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011782
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011783addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011784 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011785 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11786 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11787 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11788 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11789 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011790
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011791agent-check
11792 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011793 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011794 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11795 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11796 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011797
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011798 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011799 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011800 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11801 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11802 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011803
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011804 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11805 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11806 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11807 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11808 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011809
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011810 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011811 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011812
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011813 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11814 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11815 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011816
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011817 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11818 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11819 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011820
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011821 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11822 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11823 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11824 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11825 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011826 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011827 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011828
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011829 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11830 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011831
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011832 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11833 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11834 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11835 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11836 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11837 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11838 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11839 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11840 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011841
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011842 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11843 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011844 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11845 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11846 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011847 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011848
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011849 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011850 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011851
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011852agent-send <string>
11853 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11854 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11855 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11856 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11857 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11858
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011859agent-inter <delay>
11860 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11861 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11862
11863 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11864 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11865 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11866 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11867 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11868 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11869 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11870 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11871 of backends use the same servers.
11872
11873 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11874
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011875agent-addr <addr>
11876 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11877
11878 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11879 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11880 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11881 hostname, it will be resolved.
11882
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011883agent-port <port>
11884 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11885
11886 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11887
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011888allow-0rtt
11889 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011890 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11891 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011892
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011893alpn <protocols>
11894 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11895 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11896 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11897 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11898 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11899 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11900 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11901 now obsolete NPN extension.
11902 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11903 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11904
11905 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011907backup
11908 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11909 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11910 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11911 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011912 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11913 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011914
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011915ca-file <cafile>
11916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11917 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11918 server's certificate.
11919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011920check
11921 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011922 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11923 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11924 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11925 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11926 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11927 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11928 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011929 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11930 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011931 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11932 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011933
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011934check-send-proxy
11935 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11936 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11937 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11938 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11939 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11940 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11941 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11942
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011943check-alpn <protocols>
11944 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11945 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11946 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11947
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011948check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011949 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011950 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11951 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011952
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011953check-ssl
11954 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11955 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11956 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11957 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011958 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011959 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11960 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011961 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011962 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11963 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011964
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011965check-via-socks4
11966 This option enables outgoinng health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
11967 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11968 for normal traffic.
11969
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011970ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011971 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11972 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11973 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011974 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11975 information and recommendations see e.g.
11976 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11977 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11978 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011979
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011980ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11981 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11982 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11983 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11984 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011985 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11986 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11987 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011989cookie <value>
11990 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11991 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11992 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11993 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11994 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11995 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11996 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11997
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011998crl-file <crlfile>
11999 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12000 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12001 to verify server's certificate.
12002
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012003crt <cert>
12004 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12005 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12006 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12007 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12008 certificate request.
12009
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012010disabled
12011 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12012 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12013 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12014 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12015 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012016 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012017
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012018enabled
12019 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12020 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12021 default value.
12022 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12023 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012025error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012026 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12027 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12028 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012030 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012031
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012032fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012033 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12034 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12035 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12036
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012037force-sslv3
12038 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12039 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012040 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012041 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012042
12043force-tlsv10
12044 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012045 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012046 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012047
12048force-tlsv11
12049 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012050 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012051 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012052
12053force-tlsv12
12054 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012055 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012056 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012057
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012058force-tlsv13
12059 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12060 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012061 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012063id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012064 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12065 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12066 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012067
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012068init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12069 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12070 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012071 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012072 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12073 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12074 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12075 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12076 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12077 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12078 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12079 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12080 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012081 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012082 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12083 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12084 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12085 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12086 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12087 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012088 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012089
12090 Example:
12091 defaults
12092 # never fail on address resolution
12093 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012095inter <delay>
12096fastinter <delay>
12097downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012098 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12099 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12100 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12101 between checks depending on the server state :
12102
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012103 Server state | Interval used
12104 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12105 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12106 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12107 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12108 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12109 or yet unchecked. |
12110 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12111 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12112 | "inter" otherwise.
12113 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012115 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12116 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12117 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12118 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012119 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12120 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12121 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12122 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12123 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012125maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012126 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12127 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
12128 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
12129 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
12130 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12131 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12132 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12133 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012135maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012136 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12137 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12138 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12139 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12140 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12141 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12142 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12143
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012144max-reuse <count>
12145 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12146 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12147 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12148 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12149 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12150 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12151 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12152 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12153
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012154minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012155 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12156 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12157 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12158 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12159 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12160 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012161 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012162 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012163
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012164namespace <name>
12165 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12166 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12167 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12168 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12169
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012170no-agent-check
12171 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12172 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12173 default value.
12174 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12175 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12176
12177no-backup
12178 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12179 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12180 default value.
12181 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12182 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12183
12184no-check
12185 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12186 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12187 default value.
12188 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12189 "default-server" "check" setting.
12190
12191no-check-ssl
12192 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12193 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12194 default value.
12195 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12196 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12197
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012198no-send-proxy
12199 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12200 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12201 default value.
12202 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12203 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12204
12205no-send-proxy-v2
12206 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12207 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12208 default value.
12209 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12210 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12211
12212no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12213 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12214 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12215 default value.
12216 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12217 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12218
12219no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12220 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12221 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12222 default value.
12223 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12224 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12225
12226no-ssl
12227 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12228 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12229 default value.
12230 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12231 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12232
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012233no-ssl-reuse
12234 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12235 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12236 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12237 and for paranoid users.
12238
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012239no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012240 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12241 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012242 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012243
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012244 Supported in default-server: No
12245
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012246no-tls-tickets
12247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12248 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12249 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012250 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12251 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012252 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012253
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012254no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012255 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012256 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12257 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012258 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12259 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012260 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012261
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012262 Supported in default-server: No
12263
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012264no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012265 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012266 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12267 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012268 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12269 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012270 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012271
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012272 Supported in default-server: No
12273
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012274no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012275 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012276 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12277 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012278 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12279 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012280 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012281
12282 Supported in default-server: No
12283
12284no-tlsv13
12285 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12286 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12287 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12288 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12289 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012290 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012291
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012292 Supported in default-server: No
12293
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012294no-verifyhost
12295 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12296 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12297 default value.
12298 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12299 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012300
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012301non-stick
12302 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12303 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12304 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12305
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012306npn <protocols>
12307 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12308 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12309 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12310 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12311 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12312 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12313 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012315observe <mode>
12316 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12317 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12318 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12319 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12320 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12321 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012322 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012323
12324 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012326on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012327 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12328 Currently, four modes are available:
12329 - fastinter: force fastinter
12330 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12331 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12332 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12333 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12334
12335 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12336
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012337on-marked-down <action>
12338 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12339 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012340 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12341 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12342 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12343 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12344 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12345 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12346 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12347 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012348
12349 Actions are disabled by default
12350
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012351on-marked-up <action>
12352 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12353 Currently one action is available:
12354 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12355 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12356 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12357 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012358 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12359 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012360 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12361 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12362
12363 Actions are disabled by default
12364
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012365pool-max-conn <max>
12366 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12367 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12368 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12369 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12370 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12371 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12372
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012373pool-purge-delay <delay>
12374 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012375 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012376 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012377
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012378port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012379 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12380 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12381 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12382 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12383 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12384 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12385
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012386proto <name>
12387
12388 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12389 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12390 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12391 reported in haproxy -vv.
12392 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12393 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012395redir <prefix>
12396 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12397 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12398 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12399 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12400 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12401 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12402 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12403 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012404 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012405 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012406 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12407 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12408 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12409 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12410
12411 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012413rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012414 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12415 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12416 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12417
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012418resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12419 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12420 server.
12421
12422 Available options:
12423
12424 * allow-dup-ip
12425 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12426 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12427 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12428 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12429 For such case, simply enable this option.
12430 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12431
12432 * prevent-dup-ip
12433 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12434 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12435 same fqdn.
12436 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12437
12438 Example:
12439 backend b_myapp
12440 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12441 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12442 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12443
12444 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12445 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12446 it
12447 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12448 different address
12449
12450 Default value: not set
12451
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012452resolve-prefer <family>
12453 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12454 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12455 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12456 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12457
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012458 Default value: ipv6
12459
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012460 Example:
12461
12462 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012463
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012464resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12465 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12466 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012467 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012468 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12469 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012470 configured network, another address is selected.
12471
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012472 Example:
12473
12474 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012475
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012476resolvers <id>
12477 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12478 hostname.
12479
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012480 Example:
12481
12482 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012483
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012484 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012485
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012486send-proxy
12487 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12488 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12489 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12490 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012491 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12492 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12493 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12494 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12495 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12496 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12497 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12498 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12499 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12500 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012501 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12502 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012503
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012504send-proxy-v2
12505 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12506 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12507 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12508 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012509 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12510 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12511 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12512 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012513
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012514proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12515 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12516 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012517 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12518 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012519 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12520 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012521 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012522
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012523send-proxy-v2-ssl
12524 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12525 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12526 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12527 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12528 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12529 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12530 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012531 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12532 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012533
12534send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12535 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12536 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12537 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12538 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12539 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12540 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12541 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12542 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012543 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12544 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012546slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012547 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12548 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12549 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12550 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12551 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12552 parameters :
12553
12554 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12555 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12556
12557 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12558 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12559 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12560 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12561
12562 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12563 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12564 seen as failed.
12565
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012566sni <expression>
12567 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12568 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12569 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12570 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012571 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12572 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012573 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012574 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12575 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012576
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012577source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012578source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012579source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012580 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12581 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12582 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12583 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12584
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012585 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12586 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12587 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12588 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12589 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12590 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12591 server.
12592
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012593 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12594 specifying the source address without port(s).
12595
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012596ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012597 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12598 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12599 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12600 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12601 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12602 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012603 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12604 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012605
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012606ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12607 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12608 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12609 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12610
12611ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12612 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12613 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12614 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12615
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012616ssl-reuse
12617 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12618 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12619 default value.
12620 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12621 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12622
12623stick
12624 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12625 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12626 default value.
12627 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12628 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012629
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012630socks4 <addr>:<port>
12631 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoinng connections to the
12632 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12633 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12634
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012635tcp-ut <delay>
12636 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12637 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12638 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012639 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012640 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12641 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12642 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12643 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12644 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12645 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12646 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12647 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12648 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12649
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012650tfo
12651 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12652 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12653 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12654 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12655 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
12656 won't be able to retry the connection on failure.
12657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012658track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012659 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12660 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12661 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12662 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012663 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12664
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012665tls-tickets
12666 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12667 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12668 default value.
12669 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12670 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012671
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012672verify [none|required]
12673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012674 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012675 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12676 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012677 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012678 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12679 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12680 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12681 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12682 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12683 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12684 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12685 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012686
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012687verifyhost <hostname>
12688 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012689 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12690 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12691 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12692 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12693 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12694 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12695 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12696 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012698weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012699 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12700 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12701 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012702 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12703 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12704 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12705 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12706 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12707 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012708
12709
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127105.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12711-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012712
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012713HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12714using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12715configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012716This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12717can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12718workload.
12719This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12720resolution at run time.
12721Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12722carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12723
12724
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127255.3.1. Global overview
12726----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012727
12728As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12729different steps of the process life:
12730
12731 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12732 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12733 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12734
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012735 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12736 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012737
12738A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12739 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12740 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12741 resolution to know this new IP.
12742
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012743When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012744HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012745SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12746from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12747will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12748will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012749
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012750A few things important to notice:
12751 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12752 first valid response.
12753
12754 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12755 servers return an error.
12756
12757
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127585.3.2. The resolvers section
12759----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012760
12761This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012762HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12763contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012764
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012765When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12766uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12767is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12768answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12769
12770When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012771used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012772
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012773 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12774 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12775 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012776
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012777 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12778 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012779
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012780 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12781 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12782 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012783
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012784For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12785following scenarios are possible:
12786
12787 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12788 ignored
12789
12790 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12791 applied
12792
12793 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12794 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12795
12796 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12797 retries the query with a new type
12798
12799 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12800 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012801
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012802As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12803a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012804<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012805
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012806
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012807resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012808 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012809
12810A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12811
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012812accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012813 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012814 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012815 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12816 by RFC 6891)
12817
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012818 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12819
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012820nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12821 DNS server description:
12822 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12823 <ip> : IP address of the server
12824 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12825
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012826parse-resolv-conf
12827 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12828 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12829 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12830
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012831hold <status> <period>
12832 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12833 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012834 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012835 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012836 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12837 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12838 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12839
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012840 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012841
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012842resolve_retries <nb>
12843 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12844 giving up.
12845 Default value: 3
12846
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012847 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12848 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12849 type.
12850
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012851timeout <event> <time>
12852 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12853 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12854 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012855 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12856 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012857 Default value: 1s
12858 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012859 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012860 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012861 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12862 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12863
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012864 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012865
12866 resolvers mydns
12867 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12868 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012869 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012870 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012871 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012872 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012873 hold other 30s
12874 hold refused 30s
12875 hold nx 30s
12876 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012877 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012878 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012879
12880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128816. HTTP header manipulation
12882---------------------------
12883
12884In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12885response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12886request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12887which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012888against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012889
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012890If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12891to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12892but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12893HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12894stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12895because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12896a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12897still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012899This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12900in section 4.2 :
12901
12902 - reqadd <string>
12903 - reqallow <search>
12904 - reqiallow <search>
12905 - reqdel <search>
12906 - reqidel <search>
12907 - reqdeny <search>
12908 - reqideny <search>
12909 - reqpass <search>
12910 - reqipass <search>
12911 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12912 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12913 - reqtarpit <search>
12914 - reqitarpit <search>
12915 - rspadd <string>
12916 - rspdel <search>
12917 - rspidel <search>
12918 - rspdeny <search>
12919 - rspideny <search>
12920 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12921 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12922
12923With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12924is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12925parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12926prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12927Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12928
12929 \t for a tab
12930 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12931 \n for a new line (LF)
12932 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12933 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12934 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12935 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12936 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12937
12938The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12939portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12940above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12941regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
129429 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12943is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12944
12945The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12946after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12947
12948Notes related to these keywords :
12949---------------------------------
12950 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12951 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12952 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12953
12954 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12955 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12956 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12957
12958 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12959 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12960 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12961 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12962 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12963
12964 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12965 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12966 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12967 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12968 useless headers before adding new ones.
12969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012970 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012971 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12972
12973 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12974 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12975 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12976
12977 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12978 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012979 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012980
12981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129827. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12983----------------------------------
12984
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012985HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012986client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12987The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12988these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12989but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12990data called patterns.
12991
12992
129937.1. ACL basics
12994---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012995
12996The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12997content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12998from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12999simple :
13000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013002 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013003 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13004 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013006The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13007adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013008
13009In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013011 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013012
13013This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13014Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13015and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013016an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13017conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13018as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13019are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013020
13021ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13022'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13023which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13024
13025There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13026performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013028The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13029specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13030this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013031methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13032ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013033
13034Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13035 - boolean
13036 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13037 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13038 - string
13039 - data block
13040
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013041Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13042converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13043would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13044The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13045which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13046
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013047Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13048keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13049fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13050which are summarized in the table below :
13051
13052 +---------------------+-----------------+
13053 | Sample or converter | Default |
13054 | output type | matching method |
13055 +---------------------+-----------------+
13056 | boolean | bool |
13057 +---------------------+-----------------+
13058 | integer | int |
13059 +---------------------+-----------------+
13060 | ip | ip |
13061 +---------------------+-----------------+
13062 | string | str |
13063 +---------------------+-----------------+
13064 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13065 +---------------------+-----------------+
13066
13067Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13068matching method, see below.
13069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013070The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13071 - boolean
13072 - integer or integer range
13073 - IP address / network
13074 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13075 - regular expression
13076 - hex block
13077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013078The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13079
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013080 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13081 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013082 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013083 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013084 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013085 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013086 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013088The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13089read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13090if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13091lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13092will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13093beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13094a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13095lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13096exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13097
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013098The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13099parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13100ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13101a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13102check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13103
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013104The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13105socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13106file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013108Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13109loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13110
13111 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13112
13113In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13114the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13115case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13116as well.
13117
13118The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13119sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13120do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13121methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13122is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013123obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013124followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13125default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13126that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13127string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13128
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013129The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13130By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13131string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13132resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13133server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
13134waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
13135flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13136function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013138There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13139sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13140be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013141
13142 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13143 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013144 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13145 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13146 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13147 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013148
13149 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13150 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013151 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013152
13153 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013154 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013155
13156 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013157 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013158
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013159 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013160 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13161
13162 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13163 binary or string samples.
13164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013165 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13166 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013168 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13169 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13170 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013172 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13173 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013175 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13176 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013178 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13179 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013181 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13182 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013183 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013185 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13186 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13187 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013188
13189For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13190request, it is possible to do :
13191
13192 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13193
13194In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13195buffer, one would use the following acl :
13196
13197 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13198
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013199On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13200possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13201
13202 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013204All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13205criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13206method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13207to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13208criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13209the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013211If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013212the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13213For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013215 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13216 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13217 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13218 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013219
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013220
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013221The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13222types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13223combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13224brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13225default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013227 +-------------------------------------------------+
13228 | Input sample type |
13229 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013230 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013231 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13232 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13233 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013234 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013235 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013236 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013237 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013238 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013239 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013240 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013241 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013242 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013243 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013244 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013245 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013246 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013247 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013248 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013249 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013250 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013251 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013252 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013253 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013254 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013255 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13256 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13257 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013258
13259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132607.1.1. Matching booleans
13261------------------------
13262
13263In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13264Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13265When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13266that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13267
13268Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13269return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13270"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13271
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132737.1.2. Matching integers
13274------------------------
13275
13276Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13277enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13278to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13279
13280Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13281matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13282lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013283
13284For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13285unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13286representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13287
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013288As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13289two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13290instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13291ranges and operators.
13292
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013293For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013294operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13295Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13296of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013297
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013298Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013299
13300 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13301 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13302 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13303 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13304 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13305
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013306For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013307
13308 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13309
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013310This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13311
13312 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13313
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133157.1.3. Matching strings
13316-----------------------
13317
13318String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13319different forms :
13320
13321 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013322 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013323
13324 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013325 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013326
13327 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13328 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13329
13330 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13331 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13332
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013333 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013334 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13335 matches.
13336
13337 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13338 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13339 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013340
13341String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13342exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13343characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13344string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13345to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013346before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013347
13348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133497.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13350---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013351
13352Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13353they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13354possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13355passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13356the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013357the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13358match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013359
13360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133617.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13362-------------------------------------
13363
13364It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13365not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13366a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13367to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13368digits may be used upper or lower case.
13369
13370Example :
13371 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13372 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13373
13374
133757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13376---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013377
13378IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13379netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13380within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013381host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013382difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13383at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13384does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13385parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013386
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013387The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13388abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13389
13390 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13391 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13392 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13393 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13394 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13395 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13396 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13397 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13398
13399Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13400192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13401
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013402IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13403Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13404trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13405IPv6 patterns.
13406
13407HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13408following situations :
13409 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13410 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13411 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13412 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13413 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13414 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13415 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13416 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13417 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13418 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420
134217.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13422----------------------------------
13423
13424Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13425combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13426
13427 - AND (implicit)
13428 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13429 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013431A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013433 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013435Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13436indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013438For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13439"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13440requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13441is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13442
13443 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013444 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13445 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13446 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013447
13448To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13449and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13450
13451 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13452 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13453 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13454 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13455
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013456 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013457 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13458 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13459 use_backend www if host_www
13460
13461It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13462expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13463be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13464the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13465
13466 The following rule :
13467
13468 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013469 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013470
13471 Can also be written that way :
13472
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013473 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013474
13475It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13476to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13477simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13478sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13479good use is the following :
13480
13481 With named ACLs :
13482
13483 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13484 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13485 monitor fail if site_dead
13486
13487 With anonymous ACLs :
13488
13489 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13490
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013491See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13492keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013493
13494
134957.3. Fetching samples
13496---------------------
13497
13498Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13499against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13500sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13501ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13502of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13503available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13504
13505This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13506Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13507compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13508deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13509
13510The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13511matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13512method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13513indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13514
13515As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13516when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13517mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13518the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13519ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13520
13521Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13522multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13523when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013524incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13525are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013526is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13527all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13528
13529Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13530 - name
13531 - name(arg1)
13532 - name(arg1,arg2)
13533
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013534
135357.3.1. Converters
13536-----------------
13537
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013538Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13539of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13540is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13541was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013542has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013543unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13544
13545These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13546sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13547the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013548support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013549
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013550A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13551support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13552supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13553(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13554bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013556The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013557
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001355851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13559 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13560 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13561 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13562 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13563 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13564
13565 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013566 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13567 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013568 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13569 frontend http-in
13570 bind *:8081
13571 default_backend servers
13572 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13573 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13574
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013575add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013576 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013577 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013578 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13579 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013580 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013581 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13582 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13583 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13584 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013585 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013586 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013587
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013588aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13589 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13590 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13591 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13592 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13593 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13594 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13595
13596 Example:
13597 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13598 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13599
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013600and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013601 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013602 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013603 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13604 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013605 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013606 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13607 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13608 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13609 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013610 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013611 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013612
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013613b64dec
13614 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13615 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13616
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013617base64
13618 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013619 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013620 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13621
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013622bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013623 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013624 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013625 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013626 presence of a flag).
13627
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013628bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13629 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13630 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013631 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013632
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013633concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13634 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13635 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13636 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13637 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13638 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13639 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13640 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13641 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13642 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13643 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13644 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13645 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13646 delimitors.
13647
13648 Example:
13649 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13650 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13651 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13652 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13653
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013654cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013655 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13656 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013657
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013658crc32([<avalanche>])
13659 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13660 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13661 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13662 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13663 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13664 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13665 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13666 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13667 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13668 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013669 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13670
13671crc32c([<avalanche>])
13672 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13673 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13674 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13675 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13676 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13677 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13678 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13679 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013680
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013681da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013682 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13683 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13684 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13685 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013686 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013687 configuration language.
13688
13689 Example:
13690 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013691 bind *:8881
13692 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013693 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013694
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013695debug
13696 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13697 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13698 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13699
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013700div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013701 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13702 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013703 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013704 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13705 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013706 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013707 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13708 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13709 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13710 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013711 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013712 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013713
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013714djb2([<avalanche>])
13715 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13716 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13717 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13718 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13719 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13720 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13721 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013722 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13723 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013724
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013725even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013726 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013727 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13728
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013729field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13730 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13731 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13732 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13733 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13734 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13735 fields.
13736
13737 Example :
13738 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13739 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13740 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13741 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13742 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013743
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013744hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013745 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013746 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013747 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013748 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013749
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013750hex2i
13751 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13752 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13753
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013754http_date([<offset>])
13755 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13756 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13757 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13758 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13759 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13760 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013761
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013762in_table(<table>)
13763 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13764 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13765 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013766 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013767 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13768
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013769ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13770 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013771 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013772 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13773 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13774 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13775 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13776 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013777
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013778json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013779 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013780 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013781 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013782 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13783 of errors:
13784 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13785 bytes, ...)
13786 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13787 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13788
13789 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13790 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13791 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13792 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13793 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13794 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013795 - "ascii" : never fails;
13796 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13797 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013798 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013799 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013800 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13801 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13802
13803 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013804 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013805
13806 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013807 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013808 capture request header user-agent len 150
13809 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013810
13811 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13812 GET / HTTP/1.0
13813 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13814
13815 Output log:
13816 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13817
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013818language(<value>[,<default>])
13819 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13820 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13821 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13822 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13823 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13824 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13825 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13826 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13827 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013828 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013829 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13830 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013831
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013832 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013833
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013834 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13835 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013836
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013837 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13838 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13839 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13840 use_backend spanish if es
13841 use_backend french if fr
13842 use_backend english if en
13843 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013844
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013845length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013846 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13847 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13848 type. The result is of type integer.
13849
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013850lower
13851 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13852 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13853 type. The result is of type string.
13854
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013855ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13856 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13857 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13858 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13859 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13860 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13861 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13862
13863 Example :
13864
13865 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013866 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013867 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13868
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013869map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13870map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13871map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13872 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13873 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13874 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13875 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13876 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13877 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13878 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13879 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013880
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013881 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13882 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13883 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013884
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013885 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013886 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013887
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013888 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13889 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13890 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13891 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013892 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13893 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013894 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13895 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13896 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13897 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13898 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13899 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13900 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13901 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013902 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13903 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13904 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013905 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13906 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13907 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13908 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13909 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013910
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013911 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13912 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13913 the corresponding match text.
13914
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013915 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13916 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13917 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13918 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13919 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013920
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013921 Example :
13922
13923 # this is a comment and is ignored
13924 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13925 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13926 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13927 | | | `---------- value
13928 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13929 | `---------------------------- key
13930 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13931
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013932mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013933 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13934 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013935 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013936 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013937 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013938 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13939 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13940 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13941 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013942 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013943 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013944
13945mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013946 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013947 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13948 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013949 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013950 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013951 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013952 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13953 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13954 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13955 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013956 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013957 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013958
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013959nbsrv
13960 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13961 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13962 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13963 map lookup.
13964
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013965neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013966 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13967 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13968 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13969 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013970
13971not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013972 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013973 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013974 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013975 absence of a flag).
13976
13977odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013978 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013979 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13980
13981or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013982 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013983 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013984 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13985 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013986 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013987 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13988 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13989 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13990 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013991 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013992 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013993
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013994protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13995 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13996 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13997 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13998 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13999 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14000 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14001 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14002 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14003 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14004 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14005 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14006
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014007regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014008 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14009 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14010 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14011 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14012 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14013 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14014 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14015 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14016 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14017 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014018 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14019 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14020 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14021 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014022
14023 Example :
14024
14025 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14026 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14027 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14028 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14029
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014030capture-req(<id>)
14031 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14032 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14033
14034 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014035 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14036 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014037
14038capture-res(<id>)
14039 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14040 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14041
14042 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014043 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14044 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014045
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014046sdbm([<avalanche>])
14047 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14048 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14049 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14050 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14051 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14052 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14053 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014054 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14055 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014056
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014057set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014058 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14059 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14060 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014061 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014062 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14063 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014064 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014065 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14066 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014067 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014068 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014069
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014070sha1
14071 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14072 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14073
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014074strcmp(<var>)
14075 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14076 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14077 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14078 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14079 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14080 shorter).
14081
14082 Example :
14083
14084 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14085 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14086 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14087
14088
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014089sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014090 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14091 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014092 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014093 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14094 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014095 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014096 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14097 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014098 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014099 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14100 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014101 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014102 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014103
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014104table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14105 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14106 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14107 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14108 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14109 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14110 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14111
14112
14113table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14114 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14115 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14116 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14117 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14118 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14119 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14120
14121table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14122 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14123 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014124 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014125 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14126 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14127
14128table_conn_cur(<table>)
14129 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14130 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14131 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14132 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14133 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14134
14135table_conn_rate(<table>)
14136 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14137 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14138 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14139 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14140 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14141
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014142table_gpt0(<table>)
14143 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14144 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14145 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14146 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14147 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14148
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014149table_gpc0(<table>)
14150 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14151 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14152 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14153 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14154 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14155
14156table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14157 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14158 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14159 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14160 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14161 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14162 sample fetch keyword.
14163
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014164table_gpc1(<table>)
14165 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14166 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14167 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14168 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14169 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14170
14171table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14172 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14173 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14174 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14175 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14176 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14177 sample fetch keyword.
14178
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014179table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14180 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14181 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014182 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014183 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14184 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14185
14186table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14187 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14188 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14189 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14190 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14191 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14192 keyword.
14193
14194table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14195 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14196 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014197 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014198 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14199 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14200
14201table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14202 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14203 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14204 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14205 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14206 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14207 keyword.
14208
14209table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14210 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14211 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014212 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014213 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14214 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14215 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14216 keyword.
14217
14218table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14219 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14220 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014221 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014222 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14223 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14224 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14225 keyword.
14226
14227table_server_id(<table>)
14228 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14229 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14230 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14231 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14232 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14233 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14234
14235table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14236 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14237 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014238 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014239 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14240 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14241 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14242 keyword.
14243
14244table_sess_rate(<table>)
14245 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14246 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14247 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14248 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14249 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14250 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14251 keyword.
14252
14253table_trackers(<table>)
14254 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14255 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14256 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14257 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14258 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14259 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14260 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14261 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14262 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14263 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14264
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014265upper
14266 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14267 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14268 type. The result is of type string.
14269
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014270url_dec
14271 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14272 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14273
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014274ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014275 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014276 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14277 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14278 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014279 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14280 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14281 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14282 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014283 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014284 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14285 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014286
14287 Example:
14288 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14289 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14290
14291 message Point {
14292 int32 latitude = 1;
14293 int32 longitude = 2;
14294 }
14295
14296 message PPoint {
14297 Point point = 59;
14298 }
14299
14300 message Rectangle {
14301 // One corner of the rectangle.
14302 PPoint lo = 48;
14303 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14304 PPoint hi = 49;
14305 }
14306
14307 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14308 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14309 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14310
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014311 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14312 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14313 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
14314 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14315
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014316 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014317
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014318 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014319
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014320 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
14321 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14322 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14323
14324 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14325 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14326 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14327
14328 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14329 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14330 interpret the previous binary sample.
14331
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014332
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014333unset-var(<var name>)
14334 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14335 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14336 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14337 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14338 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14339 response),
14340 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14341 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14342 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14343 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14344
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014345utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14346 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14347 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14348 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14349 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14350 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14351 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14352
14353 Example :
14354
14355 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014356 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014357 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14358
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014359word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14360 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14361 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14362 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14363 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14364 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14365
14366 Example :
14367 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14368 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14369 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14370 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14371 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014372
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014373wt6([<avalanche>])
14374 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14375 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14376 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14377 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14378 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14379 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14380 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014381 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14382 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014383
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014384xor(<value>)
14385 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014386 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014387 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014388 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014389 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014390 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14391 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014392 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014393 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14394 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014395 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014396 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014397
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014398xxh32([<seed>])
14399 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14400 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14401 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14402 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14403 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14404 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14405 as cryptographically secure.
14406
14407xxh64([<seed>])
14408 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14409 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14410 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14411 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14412 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14413 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14414 as cryptographically secure.
14415
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014416
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144177.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014418--------------------------------------------
14419
14420A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14421not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14422"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14423The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14424
14425always_false : boolean
14426 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14427 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14428
14429always_true : boolean
14430 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14431 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14432
14433avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014434 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014435 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14436 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14437 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14438 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14439 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14440 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14441 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14442 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14443 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14444 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14445 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14446 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14447 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014449be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014450 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14451 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14452 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14453 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014454 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14455
14456be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14457 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14458 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14459 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14460 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14461 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014462 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14463 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014464
14465 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14466 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14467 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014469be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14470 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14471 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14472 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014473 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014474 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14475 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014476
14477 Example :
14478 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14479 backend dynamic
14480 mode http
14481 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14482 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014483
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014484bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014485 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14486 of the string.
14487
14488bool(<bool>) : bool
14489 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14490 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014492connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14493 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014494 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014495 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14496 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014497
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014498 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014499 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014500 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14501
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014502 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14503 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014504
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014505 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014506 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014507 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014508 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014509 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014510 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014511 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014512
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014513 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14514 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014515 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014516 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014517
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014518cpu_calls : integer
14519 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14520 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14521 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14522 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14523 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14524 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14525
14526cpu_ns_avg : integer
14527 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14528 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14529 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14530 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14531 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14532 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14533 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14534 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14535 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14536 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14537 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14538
14539cpu_ns_tot : integer
14540 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14541 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14542 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14543 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14544 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14545 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14546 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14547 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14548 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14549 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14550 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14551 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14552 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14553
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014554date([<offset>]) : integer
14555 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14556 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14557 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14558 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014559 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14560
14561 Example :
14562
14563 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14564 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014565
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014566date_us : integer
14567 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14568 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14569 from the same timeval structure.
14570
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014571distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14572 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14573 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14574 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14575 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14576 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14577 list of supported tokens.
14578
14579distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14580 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14581 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14582 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14583 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14584 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14585 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14586 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14587 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14588 supported tokens.
14589
14590 Example :
14591 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14592 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14593 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14594 # send large files to the big farm
14595 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14596
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014597env(<name>) : string
14598 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14599 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14600 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14601 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14602 certain way.
14603
14604 Examples :
14605 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14606 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14607
14608 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14609 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014611fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14612 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014613 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14614 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014615 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14616 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014617 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014618 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14619 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014620
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014621fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14622 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14623 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14624 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014626fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14627 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14628 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14629 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14630 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14631 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14632 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14633 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14634 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014635
14636 Example :
14637 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14638 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14639 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14640 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14641 frontend mail
14642 bind :25
14643 mode tcp
14644 maxconn 100
14645 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14646 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14647 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14648 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014649
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014650hostname : string
14651 Returns the system hostname.
14652
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014653int(<integer>) : signed integer
14654 Returns a signed integer.
14655
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014656ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14657 Returns an ipv4.
14658
14659ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14660 Returns an ipv6.
14661
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014662lat_ns_avg : integer
14663 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14664 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14665 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14666 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14667 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14668 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14669 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14670 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14671 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14672 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14673 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14674 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14675 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14676 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14677
14678lat_ns_tot : integer
14679 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14680 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14681 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14682 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14683 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14684 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14685 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14686 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14687 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14688 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14689 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14690 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14691 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14692 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14693 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14694 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14695 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14696 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14697 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14698
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014699meth(<method>) : method
14700 Returns a method.
14701
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014702nbproc : integer
14703 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14704 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14705 and debugging purposes.
14706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014707nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14708 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14709 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14710 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014711 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14712 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14713 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014714
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014715prio_class : integer
14716 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14717 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14718 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14719
14720prio_offset : integer
14721 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14722 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14723 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14724 set-priority-offset".
14725
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014726proc : integer
14727 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14728 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14729 debugging purposes.
14730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014731queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014732 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14733 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14734 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014735 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14736 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14737 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14738 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14739 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14740
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014741rand([<range>]) : integer
14742 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14743 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14744 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14745 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14746 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014748srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14749 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14750 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14751 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14752 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14753 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014754 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14755 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14756
14757srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14758 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14759 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14760 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14761 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14762 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14763 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14764 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14765
14766 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14767 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768
14769srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14770 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14771 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14772 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014773 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014774 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14775 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14776 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14777
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014778srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14779 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14780 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14781 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14782 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14783 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14784 fetch methods.
14785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014786srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14787 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14788 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014789 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014790 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14791 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014792 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014793 overloading servers).
14794
14795 Example :
14796 # Redirect to a separate back
14797 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14798 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14799 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14800
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014801stopping : boolean
14802 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14803 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14804 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14805
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014806str(<string>) : string
14807 Returns a string.
14808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014809table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14810 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14811 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14812
14813table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14814 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14815 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14816 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14817
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014818thread : integer
14819 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14820 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14821 and debugging purposes.
14822
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014823var(<var-name>) : undefined
14824 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014825 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14826 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014827 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014828 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14829 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014830 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014831 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14832 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014833 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014834 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014835
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200148367.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014837----------------------------------
14838
14839The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14840closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14841methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14842sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14843TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014844the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14845counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014846"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14847used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14848can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14849Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14850table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14851tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14852currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014853
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014854bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014855 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14856 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14857 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014859be_id : integer
14860 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14861 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14862
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014863be_name : string
14864 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14865 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014867dst : ip
14868 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14869 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14870 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14871 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014872 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14873 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14874 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14875 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14876 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14877 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014878
14879dst_conn : integer
14880 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14881 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14882 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14883 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14884 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14885 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14886 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14887 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014888
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014889dst_is_local : boolean
14890 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14891 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14892 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14893 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014894 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014895 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14896 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14897 it only once per connection.
14898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014899dst_port : integer
14900 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14901 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14902 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14903 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14904 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14905 an HTTP header.
14906
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014907fc_http_major : integer
14908 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14909 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14910 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14911
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014912fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14913 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14914 header.
14915
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014916fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14917 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14918 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14919 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14920 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14921 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14922 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14923
14924fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14925 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14926 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14927 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14928 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14929 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14930 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14931
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014932fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14933 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14934 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14935 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14936 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14937
14938fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14939 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14940 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14941 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14942 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14943
14944fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14945 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14946 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14947 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14948 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14949
14950fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14951 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14952 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14953 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14954 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14955
14956fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14957 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14958 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14959 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14960 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14961
14962fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14963 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14964 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14965 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14966 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14967
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014968fe_defbe : string
14969 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14970 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014972fe_id : integer
14973 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014974 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014975 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14976
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014977fe_name : string
14978 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14979 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14980 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14981
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014982sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014983sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14984sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14985sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014986 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14987 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14988 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14989
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014990sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014991sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14992sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14993sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014994 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14995 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14996 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14997
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014998sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014999sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15000sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15001sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015002 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15003 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015004 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15005 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15006 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015007
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015008 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015009 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15010 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015011 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15012 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15013 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015014 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15015 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15016
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015017sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15018sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15019sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15020sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15021 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15022 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15023 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15024 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15025 when a first ACL was verified.
15026
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015027sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015028sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15029sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15030sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015031 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015032 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15033
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015034sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015035sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15036sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15037sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015038 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15039 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15040 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15041
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015042sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015043sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15044sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15045sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015046 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15047 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15048 See also src_conn_rate.
15049
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015050sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015051sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15052sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15053sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015054 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015055 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015056
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015057sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15058sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15059sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15060sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15061 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15062 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15063
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015064sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15065sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15066sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15067sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15068 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15069 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15070
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015071sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015072sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15073sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15074sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015075 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15076 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15077 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015078 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15079 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15080 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015081
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015082sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15083sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15084sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15085sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15086 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15087 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15088 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15089 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15090 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15091 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15092
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015093sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015094sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15095sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15096sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015097 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015098 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15099 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15100
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015101sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015102sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15103sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15104sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015105 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15106 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15107 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15108 src_http_err_rate.
15109
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015110sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015111sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15112sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15113sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015114 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015115 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15116 src_http_req_cnt.
15117
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015118sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015119sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15120sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15121sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015122 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15123 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15124 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15125 src_http_req_rate.
15126
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015127sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015128sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15129sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15130sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015131 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015132 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15133 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15134 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15135 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015136
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015137 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015138 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15139 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015140 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15141
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015142sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15143sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15144sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15145sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15146 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15147 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15148 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15149 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15150 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15151
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015152sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015153sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15154sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15155sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015156 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15157 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15158 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015159
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015160sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015161sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15162sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15163sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015164 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15165 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15166 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015167
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015168sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015169sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15170sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15171sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015172 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015173 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15174 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15175 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015176 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015177 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15178
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015179sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015180sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15181sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15182sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015183 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15184 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15185 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15186 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15187 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015188 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015189
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015190sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015191sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15192sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15193sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015194 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15195 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15196 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15197
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015198sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015199sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15200sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15201sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015202 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15203 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015204 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015205 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15206 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015207 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15208 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15209 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015211so_id : integer
15212 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15213 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15214 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015217 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015218 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15219 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15220 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015221 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15222 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15223 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015224 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15225 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15226 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15227 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15228 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15229 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15230 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015231
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015232 Example:
15233 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15234 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15237 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15238 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15239 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015240 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015242src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15243 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15244 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015245 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015246 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15249 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15250 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15251 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15252 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15253 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15254 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015255
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015256 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015257 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15258 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15259 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15260 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015261 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015262 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15263 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15264
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015265src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15266 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15267 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15268 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15269 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15270 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15271 was verified.
15272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015273src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015274 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015276 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015277 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015279src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015280 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15282 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015283 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015285src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15286 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15287 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15288 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015289 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015291src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015292 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015293 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015294 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015295 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015296
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015297src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15298 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15299 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15300 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15301 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15302
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015303src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15304 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15305 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15306 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15307 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015310 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015311 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015312 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15313 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015314 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15315 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15316 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015317
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015318src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15319 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15320 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15321 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15322 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15323 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15324 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15325 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015327src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015328 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015329 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015330 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015331 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015332 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015334src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15335 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15336 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15337 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15338 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015339 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015341src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015342 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015343 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15344 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015345 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015347src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15348 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15349 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15350 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015351 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015352 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015354src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15355 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15356 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15357 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015358 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015359 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15360 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015361
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015362 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015363 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015364 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015365 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015366
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015367src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15368 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15369 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15370 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15371 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15372 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15373 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15374
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015375src_is_local : boolean
15376 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15377 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15378 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15379 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015380 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015381 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15382 once per connection.
15383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015384src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015385 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15386 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15387 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15388 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15389 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015391src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015392 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15393 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15394 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15395 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15396 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015398src_port : integer
15399 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15400 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15401 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15402 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015404src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015405 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015406 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15407 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15408 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015409 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015411src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15412 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15413 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15414 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15415 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015416 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015418src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15419 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15420 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15421 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15422 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15423 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15424 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15425 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15426 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015427
15428 Example :
15429 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15430 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15431 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15432 listen ssh
15433 bind :22
15434 mode tcp
15435 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015436 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015438 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015440srv_id : integer
15441 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15442 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15443 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015444
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154457.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015446----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15449closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15450when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15451usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015452future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015453
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001545451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15455 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15456 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15457 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15458 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15459 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15460
15461 Example :
15462 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15463 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15464 # the request.
15465 frontend http-in
15466 bind *:8081
15467 default_backend servers
15468 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15469 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15470
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015471ssl_bc : boolean
15472 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15473 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15474 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15475
15476ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15477 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15478 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15479
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015480ssl_bc_alpn : string
15481 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15482 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015483 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015484 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15485 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15486 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15487 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15488 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15489 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15490
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015491ssl_bc_cipher : string
15492 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15493 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15494
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015495ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15496 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15497 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15498 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15499
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015500ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15501 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15502 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15503 session or a TLS ticket.
15504
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015505ssl_bc_npn : string
15506 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15507 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015508 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015509 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15510 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15511 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15512 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15513 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15514
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015515ssl_bc_protocol : string
15516 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15517 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15518
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015519ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015520 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015521 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15522 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015523
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015524ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15525 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15526 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15527 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15528
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015529ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15530 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15531 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15532 if session was reused or not.
15533
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015534ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15535 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15536 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15537 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15538 BoringSSL.
15539
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015540ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15541 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15542 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15545 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15546 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15547 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15548 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15549 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15552 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15553 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15554 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15555 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015556
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015557ssl_c_der : binary
15558 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15559 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15560 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562ssl_c_err : integer
15563 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15564 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15565 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15566 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15567 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15570 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15571 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15572 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15573 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15574 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15575 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15576 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15577 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015579ssl_c_key_alg : string
15580 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15581 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15582 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015584ssl_c_notafter : string
15585 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15586 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15587 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589ssl_c_notbefore : string
15590 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15591 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15592 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015594ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15595 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15596 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15597 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15598 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15599 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15600 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15601 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15602 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604ssl_c_serial : binary
15605 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15606 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15607 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15610 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15611 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15612 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015613 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15614 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15615
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015616 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015617 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15620 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15621 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15622 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015624ssl_c_used : boolean
15625 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15626 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015628ssl_c_verify : integer
15629 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15630 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15631 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15632 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634ssl_c_version : integer
15635 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15636 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015637
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015638ssl_f_der : binary
15639 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15640 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15641 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15644 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15645 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15646 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15647 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015648 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15650 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15651 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653ssl_f_key_alg : string
15654 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15655 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15656 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015658ssl_f_notafter : string
15659 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15660 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15661 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015663ssl_f_notbefore : string
15664 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15665 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15666 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015668ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15669 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15670 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15671 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15672 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15673 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15674 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15675 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15676 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015678ssl_f_serial : binary
15679 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15680 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15681 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015682
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015683ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15684 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15685 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15686 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015688ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15689 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15690 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15691 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693ssl_f_version : integer
15694 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15695 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15696
15697ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015698 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15699 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15700 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702 Example :
15703 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15704 listen http-https
15705 bind :80
15706 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15707 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15708
15709ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15710 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15711 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15712
15713ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015714 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15716 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15717 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15718 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15719 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15720 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15721 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15722 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724ssl_fc_cipher : string
15725 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15726 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015727
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015728ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15729 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15730 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015731 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015732
15733ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15734 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15735 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015736 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015737
15738ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15739 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15740 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15741 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015742 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015743 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015744
15745ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15746 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15747 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015748 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015749
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015750ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15751 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15752 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15753 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015756 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15757 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015758 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15759 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15760 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15761 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015762
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015763ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15764 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15765 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15766 wait until the handshake happened.
15767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015768ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15769 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015770 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15771 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15772 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15773 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015774
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015775ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015776 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015777 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15778 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015781 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015782 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15783 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15784 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15785 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15786 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15787 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15788 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015790ssl_fc_protocol : string
15791 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15792 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015793
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015794ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015795 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015796 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15797 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015798
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015799ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15800 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15801 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15802 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15805 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15806 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15807 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15808 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015809
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015810ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15811 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15812 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15813 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15814 BoringSSL.
15815
15816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817ssl_fc_sni : string
15818 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15819 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15820 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15821 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15822 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15823
15824 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15825 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15826 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015827 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15828 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15832 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15835 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15836 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015837
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015838
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158397.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015842Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15843sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15844only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15845For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15846be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15847can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15848sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15849for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15850content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015853 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015854 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15855 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015857payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15858 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015859 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015860 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015861
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015862req.hdrs : string
15863 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15864 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15865 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15866 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15867
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015868req.hdrs_bin : binary
15869 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15870 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15871 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15872 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15873 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15874 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15875
15876 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15877
15878 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15879 str: <int:length><bytes>
15880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881req.len : integer
15882req_len : integer (deprecated)
15883 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15884 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15885 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15886 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15887 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15888 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15889 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15890 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15893 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015894 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15895 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15896 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15897 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015899 ACL alternatives :
15900 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15903 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15904 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15905 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15906 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908 ACL alternatives :
15909 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015911 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913req.proto_http : boolean
15914req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15915 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15916 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15917 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15918 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15919 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15920 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15921 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923 Example:
15924 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15925 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15926 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015927 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15930rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15931 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15932 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15933 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15934 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15935 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15936 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15937 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015939 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15940 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15941 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15942 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15943 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15944 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015946 ACL derivatives :
15947 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949 Example :
15950 listen tse-farm
15951 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15952 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15953 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15954 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15955 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15956 persist rdp-cookie
15957 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15958 # This is only useful makes sense if
15959 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15960 stick-table type string size 204800
15961 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15962 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15963 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15966 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15969rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15970 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15971 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15972 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15973 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975 ACL derivatives :
15976 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015977
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015978req.ssl_alpn : string
15979 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15980 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15981 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15982 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15983 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15984 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015985 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015986
15987 Examples :
15988 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15989 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15990 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015991 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015992 default_backend bk_default
15993
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015994req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15995 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15996 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015997 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15998 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15999 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16000 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16001 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16004req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16005 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16006 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16007 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16008 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16009 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16010 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16011 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016013req.ssl_sni : string
16014req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16015 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16016 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16017 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16018 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16019 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16020 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16021 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16022 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16023 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16024 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16025 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16026 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016028 ACL derivatives :
16029 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031 Examples :
16032 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16033 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16034 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16035 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16036 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016037
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016038req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16039 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16040 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16041 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16042 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16043 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16044 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16045 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16046 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16047 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049req.ssl_ver : integer
16050req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16051 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16052 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16053 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16054 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16055 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16056 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16057 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016058 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016061 ACL derivatives :
16062 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016063
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016064res.len : integer
16065 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16066 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16067 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16068 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16069 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16070 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16071 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16072 content inspection.
16073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16075 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016076 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16077 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16078 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16079 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016081res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16082 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16083 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16084 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16085 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016087 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016088
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016089res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16090rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16091 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16092 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16093 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16094 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16095 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16096 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16097 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016099wait_end : boolean
16100 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16101 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016102 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016103 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16104 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016105 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16107 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109 Examples :
16110 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16111 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16112 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016114 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16115 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16116 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16117 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16118 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16119 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16120 tcp-request content reject
16121
16122
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161237.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124--------------------------------------
16125
16126It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16127This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16128data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16129its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16130HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16131content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16132to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16133more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16134response are indexed.
16135
16136base : string
16137 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16138 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16139 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16140 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16141 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16142 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16143 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16144 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16145
16146 ACL derivatives :
16147 base : exact string match
16148 base_beg : prefix match
16149 base_dir : subdir match
16150 base_dom : domain match
16151 base_end : suffix match
16152 base_len : length match
16153 base_reg : regex match
16154 base_sub : substring match
16155
16156base32 : integer
16157 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16158 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16159 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016160 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16161 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16162 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163
16164base32+src : binary
16165 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16166 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16167 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16168 per-URL counters.
16169
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016170capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16171 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16172 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16173 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16174
16175capture.req.method : string
16176 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16177 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16178 because it's allocated.
16179
16180capture.req.uri : string
16181 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16182 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16183 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16184 allocated.
16185
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016186capture.req.ver : string
16187 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16188 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16189 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16190
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016191capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16192 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16193 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16194 The first entry is an index of 0.
16195 See also: "capture response header"
16196
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016197capture.res.ver : string
16198 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16199 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16200 persistent flag.
16201
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016202req.body : binary
16203 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16204 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16205 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16206 the first chunk is analyzed.
16207
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016208req.body_param([<name>) : string
16209 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16210 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16211 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16212 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16213 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16214 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16215 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16216 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16217 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16218 given.
16219
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016220req.body_len : integer
16221 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16222 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16223 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16224 "option http-buffer-request".
16225
16226req.body_size : integer
16227 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16228 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16229 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16230 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16231 "option http-buffer-request".
16232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016233req.cook([<name>]) : string
16234cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16235 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16236 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16237 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16238 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16239 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16240 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16241 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16242 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16243
16244 ACL derivatives :
16245 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16246 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16247 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16248 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16249 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16250 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16251 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16252 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016254req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16255cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16256 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16257 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016259req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16260cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16261 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16262 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16263 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16264 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16267 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16268 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16269 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16270 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016271 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016272 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16273 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16274 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16275 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016277hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16278 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16279 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16280 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16281 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016282 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016284req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16285 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16286 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16287 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16288 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16289 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16290 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16291 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16292 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016294req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16295 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16296 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16297 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16298 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016300req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16301 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16302 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16303 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16304 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16305 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16306 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16307 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16308 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016309 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016310 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016311 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016313 ACL derivatives :
16314 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16315 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16316 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16317 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16318 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16319 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16320 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16321 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16322
16323req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16324hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16325 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16326 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16327 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16328 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16329 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16330 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16331 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16332 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16333 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16334
16335req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16336hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16337 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16338 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16339 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16340 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16341 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016342 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016343 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16344 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16345
16346req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16347hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16348 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16349 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16350 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16351 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16352 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16353 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16354 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16355
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016356
16357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016358http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16359 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16360 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16361 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16362 basic auth is supported.
16363
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016364http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16365 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16366 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16367 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16368 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016369 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16370 basic auth is supported.
16371
16372 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016373 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16374 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16375 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16376 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016377
16378http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016379 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16380 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016381 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16382 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016384method : integer + string
16385 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16386 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16387 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16388 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16389 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16390 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16391 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016393 ACL derivatives :
16394 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016396 Example :
16397 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16398 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16399 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016401path : string
16402 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16403 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16404 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16405 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16406 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016407 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016408 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016410 ACL derivatives :
16411 path : exact string match
16412 path_beg : prefix match
16413 path_dir : subdir match
16414 path_dom : domain match
16415 path_end : suffix match
16416 path_len : length match
16417 path_reg : regex match
16418 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016419
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016420query : string
16421 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16422 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16423 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16424 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016425 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016426 which stops before the question mark.
16427
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016428req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16429 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16430 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16431 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16432 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016434req.ver : string
16435req_ver : string (deprecated)
16436 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16437 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16438 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016440 ACL derivatives :
16441 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016443res.comp : boolean
16444 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16445 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16446 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016448res.comp_algo : string
16449 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16450 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16451 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016453res.cook([<name>]) : string
16454scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16455 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16456 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16457 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016459 ACL derivatives :
16460 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016462res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16463scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16464 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16465 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16466 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016468res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16469scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16470 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16471 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16472 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016474res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16475 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16476 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16477 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16478 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16479 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16480 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16481 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16482 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16483 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016485res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16486 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16487 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16488 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16489 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16490 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016492res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16493shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16494 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16495 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16496 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16497 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16498 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16499 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16500 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16501 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016503 ACL derivatives :
16504 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16505 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16506 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16507 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16508 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16509 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16510 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16511 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16512
16513res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16514shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16515 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16516 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16517 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16518 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16519 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016521res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16522shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16523 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16524 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16525 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16526 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16527 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16528 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016529
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016530res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16531 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16532 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16533 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16534 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016536res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16537shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16538 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16539 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16540 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16541 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16542 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16543 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016545res.ver : string
16546resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16547 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16548 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016550 ACL derivatives :
16551 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016553set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16554 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16555 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016556 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016557 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016559 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16560 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016562status : integer
16563 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16564 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16565 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016566
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016567unique-id : string
16568 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16569 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16570 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16571 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16572 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16573 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016575url : string
16576 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16577 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16578 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16579 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16580 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16581 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16582 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016584 ACL derivatives :
16585 url : exact string match
16586 url_beg : prefix match
16587 url_dir : subdir match
16588 url_dom : domain match
16589 url_end : suffix match
16590 url_len : length match
16591 url_reg : regex match
16592 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016594url_ip : ip
16595 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16596 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16597 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16598 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16599 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16600 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16601 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016603url_port : integer
16604 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16605 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16606 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16607 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016608
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016609urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16610url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016611 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16612 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016613 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16614 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16615 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16616 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016617 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16618 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016619 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16620 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016622 ACL derivatives :
16623 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16624 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16625 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16626 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16627 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16628 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16629 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16630 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016631
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016633 Example :
16634 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16635 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16636 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16637 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016638
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016639urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016640 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16641 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16642 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016643
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016644url32 : integer
16645 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16646 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16647 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16648 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16649 is an unsigned integer.
16650
16651url32+src : binary
16652 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16653 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16654 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16655
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166577.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016658---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016660Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16661every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016662order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016664ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16665---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016666FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016667HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016668HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16669HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016670HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16671HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16672HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16673HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16674LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016675METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016676METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016677METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16678METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16679METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16680METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016681METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016682METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016683RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016684REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016685TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016686WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16687---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016688
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166908. Logging
16691----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016692
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016693One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16694provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16695very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16696provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16697state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016698to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016699headers.
16700
16701In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16702about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16703send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16704
16705 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16706 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16707 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16708 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16709 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016710 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016711 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016712
16713The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16714allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16715as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16716while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16717real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16718delay.
16719
16720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167218.1. Log levels
16722---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016723
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016724TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016725source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016726HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16727in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16728track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16729syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16730about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016731
16732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167338.2. Log formats
16734----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016735
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016736HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016737and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16738slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16739options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016740
16741 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16742 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16743 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16744 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16745 extents.
16746
16747 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16748 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16749 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16750 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16751 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16752
16753 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16754 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16755 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16756 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16757 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16758
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016759 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16760 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16761 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16762 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16763
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016764 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16765
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016766Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16767specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16768field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16769servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16770always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16771identifier.
16772
16773Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16774 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16775 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16776 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16777 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16778
16779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167808.2.1. Default log format
16781-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016782
16783This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16784as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16785format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16786
16787 Example :
16788 listen www
16789 mode http
16790 log global
16791 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16792
16793 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16794 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16795 (www/HTTP)
16796
16797 Field Format Extract from the example above
16798 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16799 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16800 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16801 4 'to' to
16802 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16803 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16804
16805Detailed fields description :
16806 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16807 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16808 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16809 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16810 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16811 and processed the connection.
16812 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16813
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016814In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16815"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16816connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16817
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016818It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16819will eventually disappear.
16820
16821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168228.2.2. TCP log format
16823---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016824
16825The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16826is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16827information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16828counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16829emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16830environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16831the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16832sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016833specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16834not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16835fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16836marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016837
16838 Example :
16839 frontend fnt
16840 mode tcp
16841 option tcplog
16842 log global
16843 default_backend bck
16844
16845 backend bck
16846 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16847
16848 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16849 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16850 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16851
16852 Field Format Extract from the example above
16853 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16854 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16855 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16856 4 frontend_name fnt
16857 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16858 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16859 7 bytes_read* 212
16860 8 termination_state --
16861 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16862 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16863
16864Detailed fields description :
16865 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016866 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16867 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16868 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016869 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016870 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016871 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016872
16873 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016874 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16875 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16876 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016877
16878 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16879 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16880 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016881 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16882 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16883 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16884 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016885
16886 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16887 and processed the connection.
16888
16889 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16890 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16891 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16892 applications.
16893
16894 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16895 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16896 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16897 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16898 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16899
16900 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16901 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16902 See "Timers" below for more details.
16903
16904 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16905 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16906 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16907 "Timers" below for more details.
16908
16909 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016910 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016911 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16912 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16913 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16914 details.
16915
16916 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16917 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16918 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16919 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16920 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16921
16922 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16923 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16924 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16925 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16926 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16927 for more details.
16928
16929 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016930 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016931 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16932 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16933 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016934 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016935
16936 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16937 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16938 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16939 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16940 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16941 caused by a denial of service attack.
16942
16943 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16944 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16945 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16946 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16947 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16948 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16949 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16950 denial of service attack.
16951
16952 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16953 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16954 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16955 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16956 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16957 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16958 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16959 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16960 be processed than on other servers.
16961
16962 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16963 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16964 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16965 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16966 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16967 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16968 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16969 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16970 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16971 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16972 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16973 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16974 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16975
16976 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16977 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16978 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16979 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16980 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16981 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016982 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016983 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16984
16985 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16986 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16987 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16988 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16989 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16990 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016991 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016992 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16993 occurs.
16994
16995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169968.2.3. HTTP log format
16997----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016998
16999The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17000is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17001the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17002are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17003emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17004generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17005"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17006which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017007frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17008is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017009
17010Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17011slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17012with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17013
17014 Example :
17015 frontend http-in
17016 mode http
17017 option httplog
17018 log global
17019 default_backend bck
17020
17021 backend static
17022 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17023
17024 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17025 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17026 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017027 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017028
17029 Field Format Extract from the example above
17030 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17031 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017032 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017033 4 frontend_name http-in
17034 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017035 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017036 7 status_code 200
17037 8 bytes_read* 2750
17038 9 captured_request_cookie -
17039 10 captured_response_cookie -
17040 11 termination_state ----
17041 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17042 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17043 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17044 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17045 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017046
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017047Detailed fields description :
17048 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017049 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17050 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17051 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017052 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017053 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017054 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017055
17056 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017057 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17058 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17059 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017060
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017061 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17062 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017063
17064 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17065 and processed the connection.
17066
17067 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17068 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17069 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17070
17071 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17072 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17073 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17074 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17075 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17076 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17077
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017078 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17079 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17080 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
17081 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
17082 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17083 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017084 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17085 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017086
17087 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17088 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017089 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017090
17091 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17092 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017093 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17094 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017095
17096 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17097 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17098 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17099 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17100 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017101 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17102 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017103
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017104 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17105 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17106 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17107 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17108 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17109 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17110 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017111 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017112
17113 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17114 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17115 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17116
17117 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17118 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
17119 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
17120 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17121 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17122 overflowing.
17123
17124 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17125 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17126 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17127 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17128 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17129 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17130 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17131 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17132
17133 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17134 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17135 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17136 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17137 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17138 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17139 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17140 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17141
17142 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17143 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17144 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17145 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17146 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17147 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17148 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17149
17150 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017151 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017152 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17153 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17154 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017155 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017156 system.
17157
17158 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17159 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17160 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17161 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17162 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17163 caused by a denial of service attack.
17164
17165 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17166 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17167 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17168 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17169 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17170 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17171 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17172 denial of service attack.
17173
17174 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17175 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17176 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17177 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17178 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17179 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17180 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17181 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17182 processed than on other servers.
17183
17184 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17185 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17186 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17187 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17188 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17189 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17190 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17191 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17192 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17193 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17194 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17195 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17196 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17197
17198 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17199 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17200 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17201 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17202 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17203 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017204 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017205 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17206
17207 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17208 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17209 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17210 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17211 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17212 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017213 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017214 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17215 occurs.
17216
17217 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17218 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17219 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17220 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17221 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17222 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17223 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17224 cookies" below for more details.
17225
17226 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17227 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17228 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17229 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17230 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17231 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17232 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17233 and cookies" below for more details.
17234
17235 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17236 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17237 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17238 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17239 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17240 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17241 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17242 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17243
17244
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200172458.2.4. Custom log format
17246------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017247
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017248The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017249mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017250
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017251HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017252Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17253separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17254prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17255
17256Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17257variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017258("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017259
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017260If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017261as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017262less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17263the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17264
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017265Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017266In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017267in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017268
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017269Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17270'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17271https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17272such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17273
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017274Flags are :
17275 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017276 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017277 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17278 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017279
17280 Example:
17281
17282 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17283 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17284
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017285 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17286
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017287At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17288
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017289 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17290 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017291
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017292the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017293
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017294 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17295 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17296 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017297
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017298and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17299
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017300 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17301 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017302
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017303Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17304
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017305 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017306 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017307 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17308 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17309 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017310 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17311 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17312 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017313 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017314 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17315 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017316 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017317 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17318 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017319 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017320 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017321 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017322 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017323 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017324 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017325 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017326 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17327 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17328 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17329 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17330 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017331 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017332 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17333 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017334 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017335 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17336 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017337 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17338 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17339 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017340 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017341 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17342 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017343 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017344 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17345 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17346 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017347 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017348 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017349 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17350 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17351 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17352 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017353 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017354 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017355 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017356 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017357 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017358 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017359 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17360 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17361 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017362 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017363 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17364 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017365 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017366 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17367 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017368 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017369 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017370 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017371 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017372
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017373 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017374
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017375
173768.2.5. Error log format
17377-----------------------
17378
17379When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17380protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17381By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17382"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017383will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017384logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17385
17386The format looks like this :
17387
17388 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17389 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17390 Connection error during SSL handshake
17391
17392 Field Format Extract from the example above
17393 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17394 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17395 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17396 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17397 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17398
17399These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17400failures.
17401
17402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174038.3. Advanced logging options
17404-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017405
17406Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17407just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17408options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17409for more information about their usage.
17410
17411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174128.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17413------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017414
17415It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17416haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17417commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17418monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17419ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17420
17421 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17422 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17423 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17424 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17425
17426 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17427 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17428 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017429 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017430 such as other load-balancers.
17431
17432 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17433 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17434 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17435
17436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174378.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17438----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017439
17440The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17441what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17442or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017443"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017444just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17445log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17446after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17447is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17448with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17449with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17450
17451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174528.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17453------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017454
17455Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17456for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17457"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17458retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17459raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17460a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17461file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17462you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17463"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17464
17465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174668.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17467--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017468
17469Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17470multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17471them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17472"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17473logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17474error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17475and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17476too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17477useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17478alternative.
17479
17480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174818.4. Timing events
17482------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017483
17484Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17485reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17486the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17487frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017488mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17489addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17490
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017491Timings events in HTTP mode:
17492
17493 first request 2nd request
17494 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17495 t tr t tr ...
17496 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17497 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17498 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17499 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17500 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17501
17502Timings events in TCP mode:
17503
17504 TCP session
17505 |<----------------->|
17506 t t
17507 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17508 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17509 |<------ Tt ------->|
17510
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017511 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017512 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017513 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17514 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17515 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017516 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017517 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17518 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17519 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17520 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017521
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017522 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17523 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17524 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017525 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17526 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17527 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17528 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17529 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17530 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017531
17532 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17533 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17534 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17535 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17536 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17537 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17538 request typed by hand during a test.
17539
17540 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17541 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017542 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017543 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17544 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17545 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17546 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017547
17548 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17549 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17550 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17551 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17552 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17553
17554 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17555 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17556 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17557 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17558 connection never established.
17559
17560 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17561 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17562 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17563 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17564 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17565 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17566 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17567 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17568 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17569 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17570 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17571
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017572 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17573 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17574 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17575 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17576 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17577 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17578
17579 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17580
17581 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17582 "Ta" can never be negative.
17583
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017584 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17585 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017586 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17587 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017588 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017589
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017590 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017591
17592 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017593 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17594 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017595
17596These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17597protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17598that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017599due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17600"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17601that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017602
17603Most common cases :
17604
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017605 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17606 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17607 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17608 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17609 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17610 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17611 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17612 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17613 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17614 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17615 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017616 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017617
17618 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17619 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17620 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17621 of ms on remote networks.
17622
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017623 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17624 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17625 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017626
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017627 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17628 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17629 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17630 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17631 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17632 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17633 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17634 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17635 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017636
17637Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17638
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017639 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017640 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017641 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017642
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017643 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017644 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17645 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17646
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017647 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017648 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17649 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17650 flags.
17651
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017652 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17653 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017654 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17655 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17656 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17657 the client connection was maintained open.
17658
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017659 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017660 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017661 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017662 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17663
17664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176658.5. Session state at disconnection
17666-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017667
17668TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17669"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
176702-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17671each of which has a special meaning :
17672
17673 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17674 session to terminate :
17675
17676 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17677
17678 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17679 server explicitly refused it.
17680
17681 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17682 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17683 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17684 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017685 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017686
17687 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17688 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017689
17690 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17691 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17692 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17693 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17694 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17695
17696 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17697 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17698 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17699 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17700 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17701
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017702 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17703 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17704
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017705 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17706 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17707 backup connections when going up.
17708
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017709 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17710
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017711 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17712 send or receive data.
17713
17714 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17715 send or receive data.
17716
17717 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17718 with nothing left in the buffers.
17719
17720 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17721
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017722 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017723 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17724
17725 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17726 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17727 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17728 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17729 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17730
17731 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17732 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17733
17734 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17735 server (HTTP only).
17736
17737 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17738
17739 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17740 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17741 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17742
17743 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17744 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17745 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17746
17747 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17748
17749 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17750 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17751
17752 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17753 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17754 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17755
17756 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17757 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017758 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17759 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017760
17761 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17762 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17763 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17764 another server.
17765
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017766 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017767 server.
17768
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017769 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17770 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17771 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17772 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17773
17774 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17775 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17776 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17777 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17778
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017779 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17780 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17781 "use-server" rule).
17782
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017783 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17784
17785 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17786 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17787
17788 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17789
17790 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17791 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17792 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17793
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017794 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17795 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017796 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017797 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17798 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17799
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017800 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17801
17802 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17803 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17804
17805 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17806
17807 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17808
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017809The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17810was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017811helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17812starvation, attacks, etc...
17813
17814The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17815alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17816easier finding and understanding.
17817
17818 Flags Reason
17819
17820 -- Normal termination.
17821
17822 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17823 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17824 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17825 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17826
17827 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17828 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17829 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17830 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17831 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17832 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017833
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017834 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17835 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017836 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017837
17838 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17839 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17840 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17841
17842 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17843 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17844 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17845 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17846 the server takes too long to respond.
17847
17848 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17849 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17850 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17851 long a time to respond.
17852
17853 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17854 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17855 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17856 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017857 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17858 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017859
17860 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17861 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17862 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17863 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17864 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017865 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017866 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17867 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17868 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17869 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17870 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17871 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17872 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17873 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017874 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017875 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17876 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17877 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017878
17879 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17880 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017881 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17882 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17883 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17884 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017885
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017886 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17887 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017889 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017890 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17891 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017892 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017893 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17894 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17895
17896 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17897 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17898 503 or 504 here.
17899
17900 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17901 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17902 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17903 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17904 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17905
17906 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17907 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017908 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017909 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17910 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17911
17912 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17913 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17914 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17915 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17916 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17917 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17918 between haproxy and the server.
17919
17920 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17921 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17922 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17923 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17924 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17925 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17926 solution is to fix the application.
17927
17928 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17929 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17930 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17931 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17932 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17933 external attacks.
17934
17935 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17936 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017937 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017938 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17939 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17940
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017941 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17942 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17943 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017944 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017945 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017946
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017947 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17948 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17949 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17950 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017951 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17952 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17953 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17954 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17955 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017956
17957 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17958 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17959 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17960 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17961
17962 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17963 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17964 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17965 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17966
17967 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17968 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17969 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17970 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17971
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017972The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17973persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17974important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17975re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17976
17977 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17978
17979 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17980 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17981 set on a GET request.
17982
17983 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17984 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017985 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017986 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17987
17988 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17989 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17990 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17991
17992 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17993 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17994 already got a cookie.
17995
17996 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17997 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17998 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17999 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18000 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18001
18002 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18003 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18004 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18005
18006 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18007 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18008 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18009
18010 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18011 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18012
18013 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18014 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18015 then advertised in the response.
18016
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180188.6. Non-printable characters
18019-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018020
18021In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18022consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18023converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18024prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18025being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18026escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18027is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18028'}' when logging headers.
18029
18030Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18031issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18032containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18033
18034Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18035the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18036performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18037
18038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180398.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18040---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018041
18042Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18043achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018044section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018045cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18046the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18047the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018048locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018049not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18050user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18051a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18052wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18053
18054 Examples :
18055 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18056 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18057
18058 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18059 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18060
18061
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180628.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18063---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018064
18065Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18066proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18067the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18068server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18069
18070Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18071response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018072section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018073
18074It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018075time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18076appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018077are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18078and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18079follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18080request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18081in the logs.
18082
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018083As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18084frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18085an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18086
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018087 Example :
18088 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18089 listen proxy-out
18090 mode http
18091 option httplog
18092 option logasap
18093 log global
18094 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18095
18096 # log the name of the virtual server
18097 capture request header Host len 20
18098
18099 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18100 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18101
18102 # log the beginning of the referrer
18103 capture request header Referer len 20
18104
18105 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18106 capture response header Server len 20
18107
18108 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18109 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18110
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018111 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018112 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18113
18114 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18115 capture response header Via len 20
18116
18117 # log the URL location during a redirection
18118 capture response header Location len 20
18119
18120 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18121 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18122 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18123 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18124 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18125
18126 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18127 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18128 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18129 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018130 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018131
18132 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18133 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18134 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18135 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18136 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018137 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018138
18139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181408.9. Examples of logs
18141---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018142
18143These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18144them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18145reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18146
18147 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18148 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18149 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18150
18151 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18152 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18153
18154 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18155 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18156 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18157
18158 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18159 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18160
18161 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18162 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18163 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18164
18165 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018166 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018167 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18168 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18169
18170 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18171 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18172 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18173
18174 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18175 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018176 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018177 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18178 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18179 to return the 502 and not the server.
18180
18181 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018182 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018183
18184 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18185 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18186 Nothing was sent to any server.
18187
18188 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18189 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18190
18191 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18192 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018193 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018194 send a 408 return code to the client.
18195
18196 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18197 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18198
18199 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18200 5 seconds ("c----").
18201
18202 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18203 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018204 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018205
18206 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018207 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018208 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18209 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18210 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18211 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18212 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018213
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018214
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200182159. Supported filters
18216--------------------
18217
18218Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18219accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18220unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18221
18222See also : "filter"
18223
182249.1. Trace
18225----------
18226
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018227filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018228
18229 Arguments:
18230 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18231 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18232
18233 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18234 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18235 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18236 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18237
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018238 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018239 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18240 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18241 amount of the parsed data.
18242
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018243 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018244
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018245This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18246callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18247information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18248filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18249
18250Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18251tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18252a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18253
18254
182559.2. HTTP compression
18256---------------------
18257
18258filter compression
18259
18260The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18261keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018262when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18263it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18264response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18265line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18266cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18267the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018268
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018269See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018270
18271
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200182729.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18273--------------------------------------------
18274
18275filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18276
18277 Arguments :
18278
18279 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18280 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18281 parsed.
18282
18283 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18284 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18285 part must be placed in its own scope.
18286
18287The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18288external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018289streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018290exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18291also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18292
18293SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18294the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18295
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018296For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018297"doc/SPOE.txt".
18298
18299Important note:
18300 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18301 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18302
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100183039.4. Cache
18304----------
18305
18306filter cache <name>
18307
18308 Arguments :
18309
18310 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18311
18312The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18313"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
18314cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018315other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18316the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18317mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18318filter other than the compression is used for the same
18319listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18320order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018321
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018322See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018323
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001832410. Cache
18325---------
18326
18327HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18328(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18329RAM.
18330
18331The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018332this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018333
18334If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18335independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18336when we try to allocate a new one.
18337
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018338The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018339
18340It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18341"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18342for more details.
18343
18344When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18345replaced by "<CACHE>".
18346
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001834710.1. Limitation
18348----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018349
18350The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18351
18352- If the response is not a 200
18353- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018354- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018355- If the response is not cacheable
18356
18357- If the request is not a GET
18358- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018359- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018360
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018361Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18362filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18363can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18364example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18365"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018366
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001836710.2. Setup
18368-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018369
18370To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18371the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18372
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001837310.2.1. Cache section
18374---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018375
18376cache <name>
18377 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18378 size of cache is mandatory.
18379
18380total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018381 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018382 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018383
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018384max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018385 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18386 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18387 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018388
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018389max-age <seconds>
18390 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18391 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18392 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18393 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18394 default.
18395
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001839610.2.2. Proxy section
18397---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018398
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018399http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018400 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18401 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18402 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18403 after this one.
18404
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018405http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018406 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18407 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18408 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18409 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18410
18411
18412Example:
18413
18414 backend bck1
18415 mode http
18416
18417 http-request cache-use foobar
18418 http-response cache-store foobar
18419 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18420
18421 cache foobar
18422 total-max-size 4
18423 max-age 240
18424
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018425/*
18426 * Local variables:
18427 * fill-column: 79
18428 * End:
18429 */